445
1 Introduction This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System. Please read this manual carefully to ensure proper use. Keep this manual in your vehicle at all times. The Navigation System is one of the most technologically advanced vehicle accessories ever developed. The system receives satellite sig- nals from the Global Positioning System (GPS) operated by the U.S. Department of Defense. Using these signals and other vehicle sen- sors, the system indicates your present position and assists in locating a desired destination. The navigation system is designed to select efficient routes from your present starting location to your destination. The system is also designed to direct you to a destination that is unfamiliar to you in an efficient manner. The system uses DENSO maps. The calculated routes may not be the shortest nor the least traffic congested. Your own personal local knowl- edge or “short cut” may at times be faster than the calculated routes. The navigation system’s database includes Point of Interest categories to allow you to easily select destinations such as restaurants and hotels. If a destination is not in the database, you can enter the street address or a major intersection close to it and the system will guide you there. The system will provide both a visual map and audio instructions. The au- dio instructions will announce the distance remaining and the direction to turn in approaching an intersection. These voice instructions will help you keep your eyes on the road and are timed to provide enough time to allow you to maneuver, change lanes or slow down.

Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

  • Upload
    others

  • View
    1

  • Download
    0

Embed Size (px)

Citation preview

Page 1: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

1

Introduction

This manual explains the operation of the Navigation System.Please read this manual carefully to ensure proper use. Keep thismanual in your vehicle at all times.

The Navigation System is one of the most technologically advancedvehicle accessories ever developed. The system receives satellite sig-nals from the Global Positioning System (GPS) operated by the U.S.Department of Defense. Using these signals and other vehicle sen-sors, the system indicates your present position and assists in locatinga desired destination.

The navigation system is designed to select efficient routes from yourpresent starting location to your destination. The system is also designedto direct you to a destination that is unfamiliar to you in an efficient manner.The system uses DENSO maps. The calculated routes may not be theshortest nor the least traffic congested. Your own personal local knowl-edge or “short cut” may at times be faster than the calculated routes.

The navigation system’s database includes Point of Interest categories toallow you to easily select destinations such as restaurants and hotels. Ifa destination is not in the database, you can enter the street address ora major intersection close to it and the system will guide you there.

The system will provide both a visual map and audio instructions. The au-dio instructions will announce the distance remaining and the direction toturn in approaching an intersection. These voice instructions will help youkeep your eyes on the road and are timed to provide enough time to allowyou to maneuver, change lanes or slow down.

Page 2: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

2

Please be aware that all current vehicle navigation systems havecertain limitations that may affect their ability to perform properly.The accuracy of the vehicle’s position depends on the satellite con-dition, road configuration, vehicle condition or other circumstan-ces. For more information on the limitations of the system, refer topages 426 through 427.

Page 3: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

3

For safety reasons, this manual indicatesitems requiring particular attention with thefollowing marks.

CAUTIONThis is a warning against anythingwhich may cause injury to people ifthe warning is ignored. You are in-formed about what you must or mustnot do in order to reduce the risk ofinjury to yourself and others.

NOTICE

This is a warning against anythingwhich may cause damage to the ve-hicle or its equipment if the warningis ignored. You are informed aboutwhat you must or must not do in or-der to avoid or reduce the risk of dam-age to your vehicle and its equip-ment.

INFORMATIONThis provides additional information.

This manual explains both hybrid and con-ventional gasoline vehicle information.Gasoline vehicle information is shown intriangular brackets, for example, “POW-ER” <“ENGINE START STOP”> switch.

To use this system in the safest possiblemanner, follow all the safety tips shown be-low.

This system is intended to assist in reach-ing the destination and, if used properly,can do so. The driver is solely responsiblefor the safe operation of your vehicle andthe safety of your passengers.

Do not use any feature of this system to theextent it becomes a distraction and pre-vents safe driving. The first priority whiledriving should always be the safe opera-tion of the vehicle. While driving, be sureto observe all traffic regulations.

Prior to the actual use of this system, learnhow to use it and become thoroughly famil-iar with it. Read the entire Navigation Sys-tem Owner’s Manual to make sure you un-derstand the system. Do not allow otherpeople to use this system until they haveread and understood the instructions inthis manual.

For your safety, some functions may be-come inoperable when driving. Unavail-able screen buttons are dimmed. Onlywhen the vehicle is not moving, can thedestination and route selection be done.

Important information aboutthis manual Safety Instruction

Page 4: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

4

CAUTION

� For safety, the driver should notoperate the navigation systemwhile he/she is driving.Insufficient attention to the roadand traffic may cause an accident.

� While driving, be sure to obey thetraffic regulations and maintainawareness of the road conditions.If a traffic sign on the road hasbeen changed, route guidancemay not have the updatedinformation such as the directionof a one way street.

While driving, listen to the voice instruc-tions as much as possible and glance atthe screen briefly and only when it is safe.However, do not totally rely on voice guid-ance. Use it just for reference. If the sys-tem cannot determine the current vehicleposition correctly, there is a possibility ofincorrect, late, or non−voice guidance.

The data in the system may occasionallybe incomplete. Road conditions, includingdriving restrictions (no left turns, street clo-sures, etc.) frequently change. Therefore,before following any instruction from thesystem, look to see whether the instructioncan be done safely and legally.

This system cannot warn about suchthings as the safety of an area, condition ofstreets, and availability of emergency ser-vices. If unsure about the safety of anarea, do not drive into it. Under no cir-cumstances is this system a substitutefor the driver’s personal judgement.

Use this system only in locations where itis legal to do so. Some states/provincesmay have laws prohibiting the use of videoand navigation screens next to the driver.

Page 5: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

5

Table of ContentsQuick guide —

— Remote Touch 10. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . — Map screen 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . — Registering home 14. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . — Registering preset destinations 16. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . — Operation flow: guiding the route 18. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . — Setting home as the destination 20. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Navigation system function index 22. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Quick reference (“Start” screen) 24. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Quick reference (“Destination” screen) 25. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Quick reference (“Setup” screen) 27. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Quick reference (“Information” screen) 28. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

1 Navigation System: Basic Functions⟨Basic information before operation⟩Initial screen 30. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

How to use the Remote Touch 31. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Inputting letters and numbers/List screen operation 33. . . . . . . . . . . . .

Screen adjustment 36. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Help icon 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Map screen operation 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Current position display 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screen scroll operation 39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switching the screens 45. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map scale 47. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Foot print map 48. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Orientation of the map 49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Standard map icons 49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Voice command system 50. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Natural speech information 52. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Command list 54. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Quick Guide

13

Index

Page 6: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

6

2 Navigation System: Destination SearchDestination search 68. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Selecting the search area 68. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by Home 70. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by Preset destinations 70. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Address” 71. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Point of Interest” 75. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Destination Assist” 82. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Previous Destinations” 82. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Address Book” 83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Emergency” 83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Intersection & Freeway” 84. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Map” 87. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Coordinates” 88. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting set destinations 88. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Starting route guidance 89. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

3 Navigation System: Route GuidanceRoute guidance screen 94. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Typical voice guidance prompts 97. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Distance and time to destination 99. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Setting and deleting destinations 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adding destinations 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reordering destinations 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting destinations 101. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Setting route 102. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Detour setting 102. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route overview 103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route preference 105. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Pausing and resuming guidance 107. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Show on map 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Display POI∗ icons 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route trace 112. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

∗: Point of Interest

Page 7: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

7

4 Navigation System: Memory PointsNavigation settings 116. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Setting up the “Home” 117. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up the “Preset Destinations” 119. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up the “Address Book” 122. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up the “Areas to Avoid” 128. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting previous destinations 133. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

5 Telephone and InformationTelephone (Hands−free system for cellular phone) 136. . . . . . . . .

Enter a Bluetooth� phone 140. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call on the Bluetooth� phone 145. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Receive on the Bluetooth� phone 152. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Talk on the Bluetooth� phone 152. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Fuel consumption 155. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Past record 156. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Consumption 157. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Calendar 158. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

6 Lexus Enform with Safety ConnectLexus Enform with Safety Connect−Overview 160. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination Assist 163. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . eDestination 166. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM� Sports and Stocks 170. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM NavWeather� 175. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM� NavTraffic 179. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lexus Insider 182. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 8: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

8

7 Audio/video SystemQuick reference 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Using your audio/video system 197. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Some basics 197. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Radio operation 205. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Radio operation (XM� Satellite Radio broadcast) 210. . . . . . . . . . . CD changer operation 216. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD changer operation 230. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bluetooth� audio operation 256. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . USB memory/iPod operation 264. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Audio/video remote controls (steering switches) 272. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Rear seat entertainment system features 274. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using the radio 280. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using the DVD player 281. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing an audio CD/CD text 281. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing WMA/MP3 discs 282. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing DVD video/audio 282. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using the video mode 295. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing other settings 296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Audio/video system operating hints 298. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

8 Air ConditioningAutomatic air conditioning controls 308. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

9 Rear View Monitor SystemRear view monitor system 320. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

10 Side MonitorSide monitor 326. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

11 Intuitive Parking AssistIntuitive parking assist 338. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 9: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

9

12 SetupGeneral settings 346. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Clock settings 353. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Voice settings 355. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Navigation settings 359. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Detailed navigation settings 359. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Telephone settings 368. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Volume setting 369. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Manage phone 371. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Phonebook 379. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting the phonebook 379. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Speed dials setting 388. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting call history 394. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting the voice tag 396. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bluetooth� 400. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Details 404. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Audio settings 407. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Select portable player 407. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting Bluetooth� audio 410. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Vehicle settings 415. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Maintenance 415. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Vehicle customization 420. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Intuitive parking assist setting 421. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Other settings 423. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

13 AppendixLimitations of the navigation system 426. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Map database information and updates 428. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Index 439. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 10: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

10

U0026LC

Quick guide —— Remote Touch

Page 11: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

11

No. Name Function Page

1 “MENU” button Push this button to display the “Start”(menu) screen. 24

2 “�·�” button Push this button to change the scale ofthe map and to scroll the list screen. 31, 35, 47

3“MAP/VOICE”button

Push this button to repeat a guidancevoice, cancel the map scroll, start guid-ance and display the current position.

38

4Remote Touchknob

Move this knob in the desired directionto select a function, letter and mapscreen button.

31

5 “ENTER” button Push this button to enter the selectedfunction, letter or map screen button. 31

6 “DISP” button Push this button to display the “Display”(quality control) screen. 36

Page 12: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

12

U0025LCb

No. Name Function Page

1North−up orheading−upsymbol

This symbol indicates a map view withnorth−up or heading−up. Selecting thissymbol changes the map orientation.

49

2 Scale indicator This figure indicates the map scale. 47

3 Zoom out button Select this button to reduce the mapscale. 47

4 “��Off”

Select this button to obtain a broaderview. Some of the buttons on the screenare not displayed. They are displayedagain by selecting “On��”.

365

5 “Mark”Select this button to register the currentposition or the cursor position as an ad-dress book entry.

40

6 “Route” Select this button to change the route. 100, 102

— Map screen

Page 13: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

13

No. Name Function Page

7 “Show on Map”

Select this button to browse informationabout guidance route, to set the Pointsof Interest to be displayed on thescreen, or to record the route.

108, 179

8 Zoom in button Select this button to magnify the mapscale. 47

9Foot print mapbutton

Select this button to display the foot printmap and the building information. 48

10Screenconfigurationbutton

Select this button to change the screenmode. 45

11Distance and timeto destination

Displays the distance, the estimatedtravel time to the destination, and theestimated arrival time at the destination.

99

12 XM� indicator This mark is displayed when XM� infor-mation is received. 179

13

“GPS” mark(GlobalPositioningSystem)

Whenever the vehicle is receiving sig-nals from the GPS, this mark is dis-played.

426

Page 14: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

14

U0030LCa

U0001LS

U0002LS

U0043LC

1 Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Destination” and pushthe “ENTER” button on the Re-mote Touch.

3 Select “Go Home” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

If home has not been registered, you canregister it by selecting “Go Home”.

4 Select “Yes” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

— Registering home

Page 15: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

15

U0004LC

U0005LC

U0006LC

5 There are 4 different methods tosearch your home.

See “Destination search” on page 68.

6 Select “Enter” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

The “Edit Home” screen is displayed.

7 Select “OK” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

Registration of home is complete.

You can also register home by selecting“Setup”. (See “ (a) Registering home” onpage 117.)

You can change the name, location, phonenumber and icon. (See “ (b) Editing home”on page 118.)

Page 16: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

16

U0030LCa

U0001LS

U0003LS

U0045LC

1 Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Destination” and pushthe “ENTER” button on the Re-mote Touch.

3 Select one of the presetdestination buttons and pushthe “ENTER” button on theRemote Touch.

You can set a preset destination to any pre-set destination button that has not yet beenset.

4 Select “Yes” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

— Registering preset destinations

Page 17: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

17

U0009LC

U0010LC

U0011LC

5 There are 4 different methods tosearch preset destinations.

See “Destination search” on page 68.

6 Select “Enter” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

The “Edit Preset Destination” screen is dis-played.

7 Select “OK” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

Registration of preset destinations is com-plete.

You can also register preset destinationsby selecting “Setup”.(See “ (a) Registering preset destinations”on page 120.)

You can change the name, location, phonenumber and icon. (See “ (b) Editing presetdestinations” on page 121.)

The registered points can be used on the“Destination” screen. (See “ — Destinationsearch by Preset destinations” on page70.)

Page 18: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

18

U0030LCa

U0001LS

U0004LS

U0013LC

1 Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Destination” and pushthe “ENTER” button on the Re-mote Touch.

3 There are 11 different methods tosearch destinations.

See “Destination search” on page 68.

4 Select “Go to ” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

The navigation system performs a searchfor the route.

— Operation flow: guiding the route

Page 19: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

19

U0014LC

5 Select “OK” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch, and start driving.

Routes other than the one recommendedcan also be selected. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

6 Guidance to the destination isgiven via voice and on the guid-ance screen.

Page 20: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

20

U0030LCa

U0001LS

U0002LS

U0016LCa

1 Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch.

2 Select “Destination” and pushthe “ENTER” button on the Re-mote Touch.

3 Select “Go Home” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

“Go Home” can be used if your home hasbeen registered. (To register “Home”, see“ (a) Registering home” on page 117.)

4 Select “Go to ” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch.

The navigation system performs a searchfor the route.

— Setting home as the destination

Page 21: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

21

U0017LCa

5 Select “OK” and push the“ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch, and start driving.

Routes other than the one recommendedcan also be selected. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

6 Guidance to the destination isgiven via voice and on the guid-ance screen.

Page 22: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

22

�Map�Displaying maps Page

Viewing the map screen 12

Displaying the current vehicle position 38

Viewing the current position vicinity map 39

Changing the scale 47

Changing the map orientation 49

Displaying Point of Interest 108

Displaying the estimated travel/arrival time to the destination 99

Selecting the dual map screen 45

Viewing foot print map 48

Deleting map screen buttons 365

Searching destination Page

Searching the destination (by home, Point of Interest, phone #, etc.)

68

Changing the selected search area 68

Operating the map location of the selected destination 89

�Route guidance�Before starting route guidance Page

Setting the destination 89

Viewing alternative routes 89

Starting route guidance 89

Before starting or during route guidance Page

Viewing the route 89

Adding destinations 100

Changing the route 102

Displaying the estimated travel/arrival time to the destination 99

Navigation system function index

Page 23: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

23

During route guidance Page

Pausing route guidance 107

Adjusting route guidance volume 357

Deleting the destination 88, 101

Displaying the entire route map 103

�Useful functions�Address book Page

Registering your own address book entries 122

Marking icons on the map 124

Information Page

Displaying vehicle maintenance 415

Displaying the calendar 158

Hands−free system (for cellular phone) Page

Initiating Bluetooth� 140

Making a call on the Bluetooth� phone 145

Receiving a call on the Bluetooth� phone 152

Voice command system Page

Operating the system with your voice 50

Page 24: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

24

To display the “Start” screen, push the “MENU” button on the Remote Touch.

U0005LS

1 “Destination”You can use one of 10 different methods tosearch your destination. 25, 67. . . . . . . .

2 “Info./Phone”Select this button to operate the hands−free system and display fuel economy in-formation, etc. 28, 135. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

3 “Setup”Select this button to adjust settings of thenavigation, audio and hands−free sys-tems, etc. 27, 345. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

4 “Climate”Select this button to operate the air condi-tioning system. 307. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

5 “Audio”Select this button to operate the audio sys-tem. 189. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Quick reference (“Start” screen)

Page 25: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

25

The “Destination” screen allows you to search for a destination. To display the “Destina-tion” screen, push the “MENU” button on the Remote Touch and select “Destination”.

U0006LS

1 “Address”A house number and the street addresscan be input by using the input keys.

71. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 “Point of Interest”

Select one of the many Points of Interestthat have already been stored in the sys-tem’s database. 75. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 “Destination Assist”

Provides you with live assistance findingdestinations via the Lexus Enform re-sponse center 163. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

4 “Previous Destinations”A destination can be selected from any ofthe last 100 previously set destinationsand from the previous starting point.

82. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 “Del. Dest.”

Set destinations can be deleted. 88. . . . 6 “?”

Function help for the “Destination” screencan be viewed on this screen. 38. . . . . .

Quick reference (“Destination” screen)

Page 26: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

26

7 “Address Book”The desired location can be selected froma registered entry in the “Address book”.(To register address book entries, see “(a)Registering address book entries” on page123.) 83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 “Emergency”

One of the four categories of emergencyservice points that are already stored in thesystem’s database can be selected.

83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 “Intersection & Freeway”

The names of two intersecting streets or afreeway (interstate) entrance or exit can beentered. This is helpful if only the generalvicinity, not the specific address, is known.

84. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 “Map”A destination can be selected simply byselecting the location on the displayedmap. 87. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 “Coordinates”A destination can be set using latitudesand longitudes as coordinates. 88. . . . . 12 Preset destination buttonsOne of 5 preset destination points can beselected by selecting the screen directly.If a preset destination point has not beenregistered, a message will be displayedand the setting screen will automaticallyappear. To use this function, it is neces-sary to set the “preset destination”. (Toregister a “Preset Destination”, see “(a)Registering preset destinations” on page120.) 70. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 “Go Home”A personal home address can be selectedwithout entering the address each time. If“Home” has not been registered, a mes-sage will be displayed and the settingscreen will automatically appear. To usethis function, it is necessary to set a“Home” address. (To register “Home”, see“(a) Registering home” on page 117.)

70. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 27: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

27

The items shown on the “Setup” screen can be set. To display the “Setup” screen, pushthe “MENU” button on the Remote Touch and select “Setup”.

U0007LS

1 “General”Settings are available for language selec-tion, operation sounds, automatic screenchange, etc. 346. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

2 “Clock”Used for changing settings for time zones,daylight saving time, etc. 353. . . . . . . . . .

3 “Voice”Voice guidance can be set. 355. . . . . . .

4 “Navi.”Settings are available for average cruisingspeed, displayed screen contents, POIicon categories, etc. 359. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

5 “Other”Settings are available for Lexus Insider,XM� Sports and Stocks. 423. . . . . . . . . . 6 “Vehicle”

Settings are available for vehicle informa-tion such as maintenance information.

415. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

7 “Audio”Settings are available for portable audiodevices, Bluetooth� audio devices etc.

407. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

8 “Phone”Bluetooth� phones and phone numberscan be registered, and the receiver volumecan be adjusted. 368. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Quick reference (“Setup” screen)

Page 28: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

28

This screen can be used to display the calendar and information on operation of thehands−free phone, etc. To display the “Information” screen, push the “MENU” buttonon the Remote Touch and select “Info./Phone”.

U0008LS

1 “Phone”To view hands free phone information.

140. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 “Fuel Consumption”

Fuel consumption is displayed. 155. . . . 3 “Map Data”

Displays information regarding the mapdata disc version or coverage area.

437. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 “Calendar”

To view calendar. 158. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

5 “XM NavWeather”To display the “XM NavWeather” screen.

175. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 “XM Stocks”

To display the “XM Stocks” screen.170. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

7 “XM Sports”To display the “XM Sports” screen.

170. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 “LEXUS Insider”

To display the “LEXUS Insider” screen.182. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Quick reference (“Information” screen)

Page 29: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 1

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

29

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

<Basic information before operation>

� Initial screen 30. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� How to use the Remote Touch 31. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Inputting letters and numbers/List screen operation 33. . . . . . . . .

� Screen adjustment 36. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Help icon 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Map screen operation 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Current position display 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screen scroll operation 39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switching the screens 45. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map scale 47. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Foot print map 48. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Orientation of the map 49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Standard map icons 49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Voice command system 50. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Natural speech information 52. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Command list 54. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 30: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

30

U1001LS

When the “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode, the initial screenwill be displayed and the system will beginoperating.

CAUTIONWhen the vehicle is stopped with thehybrid system operating <the enginerunning>, always apply the parkingbrake for safety.

After a few seconds, the “CAUTION”screen will be displayed.

After about 5 seconds, the “CAUTION”screen automatically switches to the mapscreen. When selecting “Show Map” orpushing the “MAP/VOICE” button on theRemote Touch, the map screen is dis-played.

Initial screen

Page 31: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

31

� Maintenance informationThis system informs about when to replacecertain parts or components and showsdealer information (if registered) on thescreen.

When the vehicle reaches a previously setdriving distance or date specified for ascheduled maintenance check, the “Infor-mation” screen will be displayed when thenavigation system is in operation.

To disable this screen, select “Do NotDisplay This Message Again”. Thisscreen goes off if the screen is not op-erated for several seconds.To prevent this information screen from be-ing displayed again, select “Do NotDisplay This Message Again”.

To register “Maintenance information”, see“—Maintenance” on page 415.

This navigation system can be operated bythe Remote Touch when the “POWER”<“ENGINE START STOP”> switch is inACCESSORY or ON <IGNITION ON>mode.

A pointer is shown on the screen. Use theRemote Touch knob to move the pointerand select the buttons on the screen.

To select a button on the screen, place thepointer on top of the button and then pushthe “ENTER” button on the RemoteTouch. Once a button has been selected,the screen will change.

When the pointer moves close to a button,it will be automatically pulled onto that but-ton. The strength of this pull can be ad-justed. (See page 350.)

The pointer will disappear from the screenif it is not moved for 6 seconds. Operationof the Remote Touch knob will cause thepointer to reappear.

How to use the RemoteTouch

Page 32: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

32

Pointer shape can be changed. (See page351.)

: Change to an arrow.

: Change to a left hand.

: Change to a right hand.

: Display of the pointer can beturned off. (Even if display of the pointer isturned off, the pointer will appear on themap screen as “+”.)

Push the “�” button on the Remote Touchto zoom in on the map screen and “�” tozoom out. These buttons can also be usedto scroll up and down on list screens.

Push the “MENU” button on the RemoteTouch to set a destination or adjust set-tings for the audio system, air conditioningsystem, etc.

You can return to the map screen by push-ing the “MAP/VOICE” button on the Re-mote Touch.

CAUTION

� Do not allow fingers, fingernails orhair to become caught in theRemote Touch as this may causean injury.

� Be careful when touching theRemote Touch in extreme tempera-tures as it may become very hot orcold due to the temperature insidethe vehicle.

NOTICE

� Do not allow the Remote Touch tocome into contact with food, liquid,stickers or lit cigarettes as doingso may cause it to change color,emit a strange odor or stop func-tioning.

� Do not subject the Remote Touchto excessive pressure or strongimpact as the knob may bend orbreak off.

� Do not allow coins, contact lensesor other such items to becomecaught in the Remote Touch as thismay cause it to stop functioning.

� Items of clothing may rip if they be-come caught on the Remote Touchknob.

� If your hand or any object is on theRemote Touch knob when the“POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is turned to AC-CESSORY mode, the RemoteTouch knob may not operate prop-erly.

INFORMATIONUnder extremely cold conditions, theRemote Touch knob may react slow-ly.

Page 33: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

33

When searching for an address or a name,or entering, letters and numbers can be in-put via the screen.

INFORMATIONKeyboard layout can be changed.(See page 349.)

� To input letters and numbersTo display the alphabet keys, select“A−Z”.

Enter letters by selecting the keys directly.

: Selecting this button erases one

letter. By holding this button, let-ters will continue to be erased.

On certain letter entry screens, letters canbe entered in upper or lower case.

: To enter in lower case.

: To enter in upper case.

Inputting letters andnumbers/List screenoperation

Page 34: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

34

� To input symbolsTo display symbol keys, select “Other”.

Enter symbols by selecting the symbolkeys directly.

: Selecting this button erases one

letter. By holding this button, let-ters will continue to be erased.

� To display the list

To search for an address or a name, select“OK”. Matching items from the databaseare listed even if the entered address orname is incomplete.

If the number of matches is five or less, thelist is displayed without selecting “OK”.

INFORMATIONThe number of matching items isshown to the right side of the screen.If the number of matching items ismore than 999, the system displays“∗∗” on the screen.

Page 35: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

35

� List screen operationWhen a list is displayed, use the appropri-ate button to scroll through the list.

To shift to the next or previouspage.

Select or to scroll through

the displayed list.

This expresses a displayed screenposition.

If appears to the right of theitem name, the complete name istoo long for the display. Selectto scroll to the end of the name.

Select to scroll to the beginningof the name.

INFORMATIONThe “�” and “�” buttons on theRemote Touch can be used to scrollup and down on list screens.

� SortingThe order of a list displayed on the screencan be rearranged.

1. Select “Sort”.

2. Select the desired sorting criteria.Sorting criteria are as follows:

“Distance”: To sort in the order of dis-tance from your current location.

“Date”: To sort in the order of the date.

“Category”: To sort in the order of thecategory.

“Icon”: To sort in the order of the icons.

“Name”: To sort in order by name.

Page 36: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

36

You can adjust the contrast, brightness,color and tone of the screen. You can alsoturn the display off, and change the screento either day or night mode.

� Contrast, brightness, color and toneadjustment

The contrast, brightness, color and tone ofthe screen can be adjusted depending onthe brightness of your surroundings. Youcan also turn the display off.

1. Push the “DISP” button on the Re-mote Touch.

Contrast and brightness adjustment2. Select the desired button to adjustcontrast and brightness.“Contrast” “+”: Strengthens the contrastof the screen.

“Contrast” “–”: Weakens the contrast ofthe screen.

“Brightness” “+”: Brightens the screen.

“Brightness” “–”: Darkens the screen.

3. After adjusting the screen, select“OK”.The screen goes off when “Screen Off” isselected. To turn the display screen backon, push the “DISP” button on the RemoteTouch again.

INFORMATIONWhen you do not select any button onthe “Display” screen for 20 seconds,the previous screen will be displayed.

Screen adjustment

Page 37: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

37

Color and tone adjustment1. Select the desired button to adjustcolor and tone.You can adjust the color and the tone whilethe DVD video, DVD audio and video CDare being played.

“Color” “R”: Strengthens the red color ofthe screen.

“Color” “G”: Strengthens the green colorof the screen.

“Tone” “+”: Strengthens the tone of thescreen.

“Tone” “–”: Weakens the tone of thescreen.

2. After adjusting the screen select“OK”.If your vehicle is equipped with the rearseat entertainment system, the rearscreen turns on or off when “Rear” is se-lected.

The screen goes off when “Screen Off” isselected. To turn the display screen backon, push the “DISP” button on the RemoteTouch again.

INFORMATIONWhen you do not select any button onthe “Display” screen for 20 seconds,the previous screen will be displayed.

� Changing between day mode andnight mode

Depending on the position of the headlightswitch, the screen changes to day mode ornight mode.

To display the screen in day mode evenwith the headlight switch on, select“Day Mode” on the adjustment screenfor brightness and contrast control.If the screen is set in day mode with theheadlight switch turned on, this condition ismemorized even with the hybrid system<engine> turned off.

Page 38: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

38

When appears on the screen, an ex-

planation of the function can be displayed.

1. Select .

U1007LS

2. Select the button of the desiredfunction.

U1006LS

When starting the navigation system, thecurrent position is displayed first.

This screen displays the current vehicleposition and a map of the surrounding localarea.

The current vehicle position mark ( 1 ) ap-pears in the center or bottom center of themap screen.

A street name will appear on the bottom ofthe screen, depending on the scale of themap ( 2 ).

You can return to this map screen thatshows your current position at any timefrom any screen by pushing the “MAP/VOICE” button on the Remote Touch.

While driving, the current vehicle positionmark is fixed on the screen and the mapmoves.

The current position is automatically set asthe vehicle receives signals from the GPS(Global Positioning System). If the currentposition is not correct, it is automaticallycorrected after the vehicle receives sig-nals from the GPS.

INFORMATION� After 12−volt battery disconnec-

tion, or on a new vehicle, the cur-rent position may not be correct.As soon as the system receivessignals from the GPS, the correctcurrent position is displayed.

� To correct the current positionmanually, see page 365.

Help iconMap screen operation — — Current position display

Page 39: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

39

When any point on the map is selected,that point moves to the center of the screenand is shown by the cursor mark ( 1 ).

Use the scroll feature to move the desiredpoint to the center of the screen for lookingat a point on the map that is different fromthe current position of the vehicle.

To scroll over the map, place the pointer ina position near the desired destination andthen press and hold the “ENTER” buttonon the Remote Touch. The map will contin-ue scrolling in that direction until the buttonis released.

A street name, city name, etc. of the se-lected point will be shown, depending onthe scale of the map ( 2 ). Distance fromthe current position to will also beshown ( 3 ).

After the screen is scrolled, the map re-mains centered at the selected locationuntil another function is activated. The cur-rent vehicle position mark will continue tomove along your actual route and maymove off the screen. When the “MAP/VOICE” button on the Remote Touch ispushed, the current vehicle position markreturns to the center of the screen and themap moves as the vehicle proceeds alongthe designated route.

INFORMATIONWhen the scroll feature is used, thecurrent vehicle position mark maydisappear from the screen. Move themap with a scroll again or push the“MAP/VOICE” button on the RemoteTouch to return to the current vehicleposition map location display.

— Screen scroll operation

Page 40: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

40

� To set the cursor position as a des-tination

A specific point on the map can be set asa destination using the scroll function.

Select “Enter ”.The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

� To register the cursor position as anaddress book entry

Address book entry registration enableseasy access to a specific point.

Select “Mark”.When you select “Mark”, the followingscreen appears for a few seconds, andthen the map screen returns.

The registered point is shown by on themap.

Page 41: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

41

To change the icon or name, etc., see “ (b)Editing address book entries” on page124.

Up to 100 address book entries can be reg-istered. If there is an attempt to registermore than 100 address book entries, anerror message will appear.

� To see information about the iconwhere the cursor is set

To display information about an icon, setthe cursor on it.

Page 42: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

42

POI INFORMATIONWhen the cursor is set on a POI icon, thename and “Info.” are displayed at the topof the screen.

Select “Info.”.

Information such as the name, address,and phone number are displayed.

If “Enter ” is selected, the position of thecursor is set as a destination.

If there is already a set destination, “Go to” and “Add to Route” are displayed.

“Go to ”: To delete the existing destina-tions and set a new one.

“Add to Route”: To add a destination.

To register this POI as an address bookentry, select “Mark”. (See page 123.)

If is selected, the registered tele-

phone number can be called.

INFORMATIONThe desired Point of Interest can bedisplayed on the map screen. (See“ — Display POI icons” on page 108.)

Page 43: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

43

ADDRESS BOOK ENTRYINFORMATIONWhen the cursor is set on an address bookentry icon, the name and “Info.” are dis-played at the top of the screen.

Select “Info.”.

Information such as the name, address,and phone number are displayed.

If “Enter ” is selected, the position of thecursor is set as a destination.

If there is already a set destination, “Go to” and “Add to Route” are displayed.

“Go to ”: To delete the existing destina-tions and set a new one.

“Add to Route”: To add a destination.

To edit an address book entry, select“Edit”. (See “(b) Editing address book en-tries” on page 124.)

To delete an address book entry, select“Delete”.

If is selected, the registered tele-

phone number can be called.

Page 44: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

44

DESTINATION INFORMATIONWhen the cursor is set on a destinationicon, the name and “Info.” are displayedon the top of the screen.

Select “Info.”.

Information such as the name, address,and phone number are displayed.

To delete a destination, select “Delete”.

If is selected, the registered tele-

phone number can be called.

XM� NavTraffic TEXT INFORMATIONWhen you select the XM� NavTraffic iconon the map, the XM� NavTraffic info. barwill appear on the upper part of the screen.

Select “Info.”.

Traffic information is displayed on thescreen.

Select “Detail” to display detailed trafficevent information.

Page 45: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

45

Any one of the screen configurations canbe selected .

1. Select this button to display the fol-lowing screen.

2. To select the desired screen config-uration, select one of the following but-tons.

Depending on the conditions, certainscreen configuration buttons cannot beselected.

:To display the single map screen.(See page 46.)

:To display the dual map screen.(See page 46.)

:To display the compass modescreen. (See page 47.)

:To display the freeway screen.(See page 94.)

:To display the turn list screen.(See page 96.)

:To display the arrow screen. (Seepage 96.)

:To display the intersection guid-ance screen or the guidancescreen on the freeway. (See page95.)

— Switching the screens

Page 46: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

46

� Screen configurationsSINGLE MAPThis is a regular map screen.

While on a different screen, selecting

will display the singlemap screen.

The screen shows the single map.

DUAL MAPA map can be displayed split in two.

While on a different screen, selecting

will display the dual mapscreen.

The screen shows the dual map. The mapon the left is the main map.

The right side map can be edited by select-ing any specific point on the right side map.

This screen can perform the following pro-cedures:

1. Changing the map scale2. Displaying the POI icon3. Show XM� NavTraffic Info. (See page

179.)

4. Changing the orientation of the map

Select “OK” when you complete edi-ting.The screen returns to the dual map screen.

Page 47: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

47

COMPASS MODECurrent vehicle position is indicated with acompass.

While on a different screen, selecting

will display the compassmode screen.

Information about the destination and cur-rent position, as well as a compass, is dis-played on the screen.

The destination mark is displayed in the di-rection of the destination. When driving re-fer to the longitude and latitude coordi-nates, and the compass, to make sure thatyour vehicle is headed in the direction ofthe destination.

INFORMATIONWhen the vehicle travels out of thecoverage area, the guidance screenchanges to the compass modescreen.

Select or to change the scale

of the map display. The scale bar and indi-cator at the bottom of the screen indicatesthe map scale menu. The scale range is150 feet (50 m) to 250 miles (400 km).

Select or until the scale bar

changes normally. By continuing to selectthe button, the scale bar changes smooth-ly.

The scale of the map display can bechanged by selecting the scale bar direct-ly. It is not available while driving.

The map scale is displayed under thenorth−up symbol or heading−up symbol atthe top left of the screen.

INFORMATION� Push the “�” button on the

Remote Touch to zoom in on themap screen and “�” to zoom out.

� When the map scale is at the maxi-mum range of 250 miles (400 km),

is not shown. When the mapscale is at the minimum range of150 feet (50 m), is not shown.In areas where the foot print map isavailable the map scale changesfrom to when at theminimum range.

— Map scale

Page 48: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

48

For the area which is covered by the footprint map (Some areas in the followingcities: Detroit, Chicago, N.Y., L.A), you canswitch to the foot print map on a scale of 75feet (25 m).

� To switch to the foot print map

changes into when the map

is scaled down to 150 feet (50 m).

To display the foot print map, select.

To delete the foot print map display, select

.

INFORMATION� If the map or the current position is

moved to the area which is not cov-ered by the foot print map, thescreen scale automaticallychanges to 150 feet (50 m).

� On the foot print map, a one waystreet is displayed by .

� It is not possible to perform scroll-ing on the foot print map while driv-ing.

The building footprints and related car-tographic information in this productcomes with MAPMASTER digital mate-rials.

� To display building informationInformation is available only for buildingsfor which information is recorded on themap disc.

Select “Info.” while the foot print map isdisplayed.

Details of POIs in some buildings may bedisplayed.

For detailed POI information, select thebuilding name. You can see details of theselected POIs.

— Foot print map

Page 49: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

49

The orientation of the map can be changedfrom North−up to Heading−up by selectingthe orientation symbol at the top left of thescreen.

Select or .

� North−up screen

� Heading−up screen

North−up symbol

Regardless of the direction of vehicle trav-el, North is always up.

Heading−up symbol

The direction of vehicle travel is always up.A red arrow indicates North.

Icon Name

Island

Park

Industry

Business facility

Airport

Military

University

Hospital

Stadium

Shopping mall

Golf

— Orientation of the map — Standard map icons

Page 50: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

50

The voice command system enables youto operate the navigation system, audiosystem and hands−free system by givinga command.

1. Push the talk switch.After a beep sounds, the “Voice Menu”screen is displayed.

INFORMATION� Voice guidance for the voice com-

mand system can be skipped bypushing the talk switch.

� The voice recognition prompt canbe set to on or off when “VoicePrompts (on/off)’’ is selected.This setting can also be changedon the “Voice Settings’’ screen.(See page 356.)

� When “Voice Prompts (on/off)’’ isselected, voice recognition will betemporarily suspended.Push the talk switch again.

� Voice guidance can be canceled bysetting voice prompts to off.Use this setting when you want tosay a command immediately afterpushing the talk switch.

2. After a beep sounds, say the com-mand of your choice.

Voice commands are marked with .

Some commonly used commands are dis-played on the screen. Speak the com-mands as displayed on the screen.

If you want to check the all command list,say “Command list” to display the com-mand list screen. (See “—Command list”on page 54.)

Voice command system—

Page 51: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

51

3. Following voice guidance, say thecommand displayed on the screen.If a desired outcome is not shown, or if nochoices are available, say “Go back” orselect “Go Back” to return to the previousscreen.

To cancel voice command recognition, say“Cancel”, select “Cancel”, or push andhold the talk switch.

If the navigation system does not respondor the confirmation screen does not disap-pear, please push the talk switch and tryagain.

If a voice command cannot be recognizedwithin 6 seconds, the voice guidance sys-tem will say “Pardon?” (“Command notrecognized.” will be displayed on thescreen) and voice command reception willrestart.

If a voice command cannot be recognizedtwo consecutive times, the voice guidancesystem will say “Paused. To restart voicerecognition, push the talk switch.”, then besuspended.

� Microphone

It is unnecessary to speak directly intothe microphone when giving a com-mand.

INFORMATION� Wait for the confirmation beep be-

fore speaking a command.� Voice commands may not be rec-

ognized if :� Spoken too quickly� Spoken at a low or high volume� The windows or sunroof are open� Passengers are talking while

voice commands are spoken� The air conditioning speed is set

high� The command is not correct or

clear.Note that certain words, accents,or speech patterns may be diffi-cult for the system to recognize.

� There are some noises such aswind noise, etc.

Page 52: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

52

� Voice command example: Search-ing for a route to your home.

1. Push the talk switch.2. Say “Go home”.If a home address is not registered, thevoice guidance system will say “Yourhome is not set” and you will be promptedto enter a home address. (See page 117.)

When the voice command is recognized,a map of the area around your home is dis-played.

3. Select “Enter” or say “Enter”, andthe system starts searching for a routeto your home.To return to the “Voice Menu” screen, say“Go back” or select “Go Back”.

Select “Cancel” or say “Cancel”, and thevoice command system will be canceled.

Due to natural language speech recogni-tion technology, this system enables rec-ognition of a command when spoken natu-rally. However, the system cannotrecognize every variation of each com-mand. In some situations, it is possible toomit the command for the procedure anddirectly state the desired operation.

� Voice recognition top screen ex-pression examples

Command Expression examples

Go Home Take me home.Let’s go home.

Destination I’d like to set a des-tination.

Phone I’d like to make a call.I need to use thephone. Bring up the phonemenu.

Audio Audio menu, please.

Information Let me see the infor-mation menu. Give us the informa-tion menu, please.

Command List Show me the voicecommand list.

— Natural speechinformation (English only)

Page 53: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

53

� Expression examples for each func-tion

In some situations, It is possible to omit acommand for each procedure and to saythe desired operation directly.

EXPRESSION EXAMPLES WITH THE“Destination” SCREENNormal command recognition —

Destination>Point of Interest>NearHere>Gas> The gas stations near the cur-rent location will be listed.

Natural speech recognition —

Destination> What gas stations arenearby?> The gas stations near the cur-rent location will be listed.

INFORMATIONNatural speech example:“Where’s the nearest Mexican restau-rant?”“Where is the closest ATM?”

EXPRESSION EXAMPLES WITH THE“Phone Menu” SCREEN (when makinga call using a phonebook)Normal command recognition —

Phone>Dial by Name>Bob>mobile> Thephone number will be displayed.

Natural speech recognition —

Phone>Call to Bob on his mobile.> Thephone number will be displayed.

INFORMATIONNatural speech example:“Get me Rob Brown on the phone.”“Please place a call to John on hismobile.”

EXPRESSION EXAMPLES WITH THE“Phone Menu” SCREEN (when makinga call by saying a phone number)Normal command recognition —

Phone>Dial by Number>123−456−789>The phone number will be displayed.

Natural speech recognition —

Phone>Call to 123−456−789.> Thephone number will be displayed.

INFORMATIONThe above mentioned command formaking a call can also be recognizedon the voice recognition top screen.Natural speech example:“I’d like to place a call to123−456−789.”“I want to buzz 123−456−789, please.”

Page 54: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

54

EXPRESSION EXAMPLES WITH THE“Information Menu” SCREENNormal command recognition —

Information>XM Nav Weather>Los An-geles, California> The weather informa-tion will be displayed.

Natural speech recognition —

Information>Give me a weather reportfor Los Angeles, California.> Theweather information will be displayed.

INFORMATIONNatural speech example:“How about Detroit, Michigan?”

EXPRESSION EXAMPLES WITH THE“Audio Menu” SCREEN (when the au-dio source is in satellite radio mode)Normal command recognition —

Audio>Select Channel Number>90> Thechannel will be changed to the one se-lected.

Natural speech recognition —

Audio>Play channel ninety, please> Thechannel will be changed to the one se-lected.

INFORMATIONNatural speech example:“Switch the channel to XM one seven-ty five.”

VOICE RECOGNITION TOP SCREENEXPRESSION EXAMPLESNormal command recognition —

Command List>Dual Map> The map willbe displayed in dual map mode.

Natural speech recognition —

Switch to dual map mode.> The map willbe displayed in dual map mode.

The system has a voice recognition com-mand list. You can operate the voicerecognition system by saying any com-mand from the displayed command list.

1. Push the talk switch.

2. Say “Command list”.

3. Say the command of your choice tooperate the system.To confirm commands on the screen, se-

lect or to scroll through the com-

mand list. This function is available onlywhen the vehicle is not moving.

— Command list

Page 55: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

55

INFORMATIONWhen the “Voice Menu” screen is dis-played, all the commands in the voicerecognition command list can be rec-ognized.

� Voice command example: Changingmap screen

1. Push the talk switch.2. Say “Command list”.

3. Say “Dual map”.To confirm commands on the screen, se-

lect or to scroll through the com-

mand list. This function is available onlywhen the vehicle is not moving.

When or is selected, push the talk

switch again and say the command.

The screen shows the dual map.

Page 56: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

56

� Voice command example: Changingmap scale

1. Push the talk switch.2. Say “Command list”.

3. Say “Zoom in” or “Zoom out”.To confirm commands on the screen, se-

lect or to scroll through the com-

mand list. This function is available onlywhen the vehicle is not moving.

When or is selected, push the talk

switch again and say the command.

The scale of the map display is changed.

Page 57: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

57

COMMAND LIST

Change map mode

Command Action

Map Shows current position map.

Dual map Changes map to dual mode.

Single map Changes map to single mode.

Compass mode Changes map to compass mode.

Change map scale

Command Action

Zoom in Zoom in.

Zoom out Zoom out.

Right map zoom in Zooms right map in.

Right map zoom out Zooms right map out.

Change map orientation

Command Action

North up Changes map bearing to north up.

Heading up Changes map bearing to heading up.

Map direction Changes map bearing to another direc-tion.

Right map north up Changes right map bearing to north up.

Right map heading up Changes right map bearing to headingup.

Right map direction Changes right map bearing to anotherdirection.

Change guidance mode

Command Action

Arrow mode Changes guidance screen to arrowmode.

Turn list mode Changes guidance screen to turn listmode.

Page 58: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

58

Change guidance mode

Command Action

Freeway mode Changes guidance screen to freewaymode.

Intersection mode Changes guidance screen to Intersec-tion mode.

Set a destination

Command Action

Previous start point Calculates route to previous start point.

Save a point on the map

Command Action

Mark this point Marks the point on the map.

Change route

Command Action

Quick route Changes route to quick route.

Short route Changes route to short route.

Alternate route Changes route to alternate route.

Detour Calculates detour route.

Detour entire route Calculates detour entire route.

Review route

Command Action

Route overview Shows entire route.

Next destination map Shows position of next destination.

First destination map Shows position of first destination.

Second destination map Shows position of second destination.

Third destination map Shows position of third destination.

Fourth destination map Shows position of fourth destination.

Fifth destination map Shows position of fifth destination.

Final destination map Shows position of final destination.

Page 59: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

59

Delete destination

Command Action

Delete next destination Deletes position of next destination.

Delete final destination Deletes position of final destination.

Delete all destinations Deletes position of all destination.

Guidance options

Command Action

Pause guidance Pauses the guidance.

Resume guidance Resumes the guidance.

Repeat guidance Repeat voice guidance.

Louder Turns volume up 1 level.

Softer Turns volume down 1 level.

Traffic information

Command Action

Traffic information Displays traffic information.

Show POI icons

Command Action

SHOW GAS Displays GAS STATION icons.

SHOW PARKING Displays PARKING icons.

SHOW SERVICE AND MAINTENANCE Displays SERVICE & MAINTENANCEicons.

SHOW DEALERSHIPS Displays DEALERSHIP icons.

SHOW LEXUS Displays LEXUS DEALERSHIP icons.

SHOW TOYOTA Displays TOYOTA DEALERSHIP icons.

SHOW PARTS STORES Displays PARTS STORE icons.

SHOW ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE Displays ROADSIDE ASSISTANCEicons.

SHOW AUTOMOBILE CLUBS Displays AUTOMOBILE CLUB icons.

SHOW CAR RENTAL AGENCIES Displays CAR RENTAL AGENCY icons.

SHOW CAR WASHES Displays CAR WASH icons.

SHOW OTHER AUTOMOTIVE Displays OTHER AUTOMOTIVESTORE icons.

SHOW DINING Displays DINING icons.

Page 60: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

60

Show POI icons

Command Action

SHOW AMERICAN DINING Displays AMERICAN RESTAURANTicons.

SHOW BAKERIES AND DELIS Displays BAKERY & DELI icons.

SHOW BARBECUE AND GRILL DI-NING

Displays BARBECUE & GRILL RES-TAURANT icons.

SHOW CAJUN AND CARIBBEAN DIN-ING

Displays CAJUN & CARIBBEAN RES-TAURANT icons.

SHOW CHINESE DINING Displays CHINESE RESTAURANTicons.

SHOW COFFEE HOUSES Displays COFFEE HOUSE icons.

SHOW FAST FOOD Displays FAST FOOD icons.

SHOW FRENCH DINING Displays FRENCH RESTAURANT icons.

SHOW GREEK DINING Displays GREEK RESTAURANT icons.

SHOW INDIAN DINING Displays INDIAN RESTAURANT icons.

SHOW ICE CREAM AND CANDY Displays ICE CREAM & CANDY icons.

SHOW ITALIAN DINING Displays ITALIAN RESTAURANT icons.

SHOW JAPANESE DINING Displays JAPANESE RESTAURANTicons.

SHOW KOREAN DINING Displays KOREAN RESTAURANTicons.

SHOW LATIN AND SOUTH AMERICANDINING

Displays LATIN & SOUTH AMERICANRESTAURANT icons.

SHOW MIDDLE EASTERN DINING Displays MIDDLE EASTERN RES-TAURANT icons.

SHOW MEXICAN DINING Displays MEXICAN RESTAURANTicons.

SHOW PIZZA Displays PIZZERIA icons.

SHOW SEAFOOD DINING Displays SEAFOOD RESTAURANTicons.

SHOW SPANISH DINING Displays SPANISH RESTAURANTicons.

SHOW STEAK HOUSES Displays STEAK HOUSE icons.

SHOW THAI DINING Displays THAI RESTAURANT icons.

Page 61: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

61

Show POI icons

Command Action

SHOW VIETNAMESE DINING Displays VIETNAMESE RESTAURANTicons.

SHOW OTHER DINING Displays OTHER RESTAURANT icons.

SHOW GROCERIES Displays GROCERY STORE icons.

SHOW SHOPPING MALLS Displays SHOPPING MALL icons.

SHOW CONVENIENCE STORES Displays CONVENIENCE STORE icons.

SHOW HOME IMPROVEMENT Displays HOME IMPROVEMENT icons.

SHOW OFFICE AND ELECTRONICS Displays OFFICE & ELECTRONICSicons.

SHOW RETAIL AND DEPARTMENTSTORES

Displays RETAIL & DEPARTMENTSTORE icons.

SHOW DEPARTMENT STORES Displays DEPARTMENT STORE icons.

SHOW BOOK STORES Displays BOOK STORE icons.

SHOW CLOTHING AND SHOESTORES

Displays CLOTHING & SHOES STOREicons.

SHOW HOBBY AND CRAFTS Displays HOBBY & CRAFT icons.

SHOW JEWELRY Displays JEWELRY icons.

SHOW SPORTING EQUIPMENT Displays SPORTING EQUIPMENTicons.

SHOW RECREATIONAL VEHICLES Displays RECREATIONAL VEHICLEicons.

SHOW OTHER RETAIL STORES Displays OTHER RETAIL STORE icons.

SHOW POLICE STATIONS Displays POLICE STATION icons.

SHOW FIRE STATIONS Displays FIRE STATION icons.

SHOW HOSPITALS Displays HOSPITAL icons.

SHOW PHARMACIES Displays PHARMACY icons.

SHOW OTHER MEDICAL FACILITIES Displays OTHER MEDICAL FACILITYicons.

SHOW HOTELS Displays HOTEL icons.

SHOW REST AREAS Displays REST AREA icons.

SHOW AIRPORTS Displays AIRPORT icons.

SHOW BUS STATIONS Displays BUS STATION icons.

Page 62: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

62

Show POI icons

Command Action

SHOW TRAIN STATIONS Displays TRAIN STATION icons.

SHOW PORTS AND FERRIES Displays PORT & FERRY icons.

SHOW TAXIS AND SHUTTLES Displays TAXI & SHUTTLE icons.

SHOW FULL SERVICE BANKS Displays FULL−SERVICE BANKS icons.

SHOW ATMS Displays ATM icons.

SHOW ATTRACTIONS Displays ATTRACTIONS icons.

SHOW ENTERTAINMENT Displays ENTERTAINMENT icons.

SHOW TOURIST INFORMATION Displays TOURIST INFORMATIONicons.

SHOW PARKS AND BEACHES Displays PARK & BEACH icons.

SHOW SPORTS AND FITNESS Displays SPORTS & FITNESS icons.

SHOW BOWLING CENTERS Displays BOWLING icons.

SHOW GOLF COURSES Displays GOLF COURSE icons.

SHOW HORSE RACING Displays HORSE RACING icons.

SHOW HEALTH AND FITNESS CLUBS Displays HEALTH & FITNESS CLUBicons.

SHOW MARINAS Displays MARINA icons.

SHOW MOTOR SPORTS Displays MOTOR SPORTS icons.

SHOW SKI RESORTS Displays SKI RESORT icons.

SHOW SPORTS COMPLEXES Displays SPORTS COMPLEX icons.

SHOW NIGHTLIFE Displays NIGHTLIFE icons.

SHOW PERFORMING ARTS Displays PERFORMING ART icons.

SHOW CITY CENTERS Displays CITY CENTER icons.

SHOW GOVERNMENT Displays GOVERNMENT icons.

SHOW SCHOOLS Displays SCHOOL icons.

SHOW DRY CLEANERS Displays DRY CLEANING icons.

SHOW FLORISTS Displays FLORIST icons.

SHOW LIBRARIES Displays LIBRARY icons.

SHOW PERSONAL GROOMING Displays PERSONAL GROOMINGicons.

Page 63: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

63

Show POI icons

Command Action

SHOW SHIPPING AND COPIES Displays SHIPPING & COPY icons.

SHOW POST OFFICES Displays POST OFFICE icons.

SHOW OTHER SERVICES Displays OTHER SERVICE icons.

Delete POI icons

Command Action

Clear all icons Deletes all POI icons.

Select audio mode

Command Action

Radio Selects audio mode to radio.

AM Selects audio mode to AM.

FM Selects audio mode to FM.

FM1 Selects audio mode to FM1.

FM2 Selects audio mode to FM2.

Satellite radio Selects audio mode to satellite radio.

Satellite radio 1 Selects audio mode to satellite radio 1.

Satellite radio 2 Selects audio mode to satellite radio 2.

Satellite radio 3 Selects audio mode to satellite radio 3.

CD Selects audio mode to CD.

DVD Selects audio mode to DVD.

CD changer Selects audio mode to CD changer.

DVD changer Selects audio mode to DVD changer.

Auxiliary Selects audio mode to auxiliary.

Bluetooth audio Selects audio mode to Bluetooth� audio.

iPod Selects audio mode to iPod.

USB audio Selects audio mode to USB audio.

Audio On/Off

Command Action

Audio on / Audio off Turns audio system on and off.

Page 64: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

64

Radio operation

Command Action

Seek up Seeks up for a radio station.

Seek down Seeks down for a radio station.

Type up Seeks up for program type.

Type down Seeks down for program type.

Disc operation

Command Action

Track up Tracks up for a track number.

Track down Tracks down for a track number.

Previous track Selects previous track.

Disc up Disc up.

Disc down Disc down.

Climate command

Command Action

Automatic climate control Turns air conditioner on and off.

Raise temperature Turns temperature up.

Lower temperature Turns temperature down.

?? degrees (?? is 65 to 85) Selects temperature from 65 to 80 de-grees.

Phone

Command Action

Dial by number Calls by phone number.

Dial by name Calls by giving a voice tag in thephonebook.

Select phone Selects phone.

Page 65: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

65

INFORMATION� The function that cannot be used

according to the vehicle is pro-vided.

� Voice recognition language can bechanged. (See “� Selecting a lan-guage” on page 348.)

Page 66: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: BASIC FUNCTIONS

66

Page 67: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 2

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

67

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

� Destination search 68. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Selecting the search area 68. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by Home 70. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by Preset destinations 70. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Address” 71. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Point of Interest” 75. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Destination Assist” 82. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Previous Destinations” 82. . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Address Book” 83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Emergency” 83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Intersection & Freeway” 84. . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Map” 87. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Coordinates” 88. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting set destinations 88. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Starting route guidance 89. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 68: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

68

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U0001LS

2. Select “Destination”.

U0004LS

You can use one of 11 different methods tosearch your destination. (See pages 70through 88.)

INFORMATIONWhen searching the destination, theresponse to the screen button may beslow.

Change the selected region in order to seta destination from a different region by us-ing “Address”, “Point of Interest” or “Inter-section & Freeway”.

1. Select “Search Area” to display amap of the United States and Canadadivided into 15 regions. (For map data-base information and updates, see “Mapdatabase information and updates” onpage 428.)

2. Select one of “US1” through “CAN”to select a region to search.3. Select “OK” and the previousscreen returns.

Destination search — — Selecting the search area

Page 69: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

69

U.S.A.

ButtonStates included in the searchregion

“US1”IdahoOregonWashington

“US2”CaliforniaNevada

“US3”

ArizonaColoradoMontanaNew MexicoUtahWyoming

“US4”

IowaKansasMinnesotaMissouriNorth DakotaNebraskaSouth Dakota

“US5”OklahomaTexas

“US6”

IllinoisIndianaKentuckyMichiganOhioWisconsin

“US7”

ArkansasAlabamaLouisianaMississippiTennessee

“US8”

ConnecticutMassachusettsMaineNew HampshireNew JerseyNew YorkRhode IslandVermont

“US9”

Washington, D.C.DelawareMarylandNew JerseyPennsylvaniaVirginiaWest Virginia

“US10”

FloridaGeorgiaNorth CarolinaSouth Carolina

“HI” Hawaii

“AK” Alaska

“PR” Puerto Rico

“VI” US Virgin Islands

Canada

ButtonProvinces and regions in-cluded in the search region

“CAN”All provinces and regions inCanada included in this button.

Page 70: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

70

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.

U0002LS

3. Select “Go Home”.The screen changes and displays the maplocation for home and the route prefer-ence. (See “Starting route guidance” onpage 89.)

If home has not been registered, a mes-sage will be displayed and the settingscreen will automatically appear.

To use this function, it is necessary to seta “Home” address. (To register “Home”,see page 117.)

INFORMATIONGuidance starts from the current ve-hicle position to your home if “OK” isselected even while driving.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.

U0003LS

3. Select any of the preset destinationbuttons on the “Destination” screen.The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the preset destination point andthe route preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

If a preset destination point has not beenregistered, a message will be displayedand the setting screen will automaticallyappear.

To use this function, it is necessary to set“Preset Destinations”. (To register “PresetDestinations”, see page 119.)

INFORMATIONGuidance starts from the current ve-hicle position to the preset destina-tion point if “Go to ” is selectedeven while driving.

— Destination search byHome

— Destination search byPreset destinations

Page 71: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

71

There are 2 ways to search a destinationby address.(a) Search by city(b) Search by street address

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Address” on the “Destina-tion” screen.

4. Select the button for the desiredmethod.

(a) Selecting a city to search1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Destination”.2. Select “Address” on the “Destina-tion” screen.

3. Select “City”.

4. Input a city name.

5. Select the button of the desired cityname from the displayed list.

— Destination search by“Address”

Page 72: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

72

6. Input the street name and select“OK”.

7. When the desired street name isfound, select the corresponding but-ton.The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

8. Input a house number.

If the same address exists in more thanone city, the current screen changes to theaddress list screen.

Page 73: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

73

SELECTING FROM THE LAST 5 CITIES

1. Select “Last 5 Cities”.

2. Select the button of the desired cityname.If the navigation system has never beenused, this function will not be available.

The current screen changes to the screenfor inputting a street name. (See “(a) Se-lecting a city to search” on page 71.)

(b) Search by street address1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Destination”.2. Select “Address” on the “Destina-tion” screen.

3. Select “Street Address”.

4. Select numbers directly on thescreen to input a house number.After inputting a house number, select“OK” to display the screen for inputting astreet name.

5. Input the street name and select“OK”.

Page 74: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

74

6. When the desired street name isfound, select the corresponding but-ton.The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

If the same address exists in more thanone city, the current screen changes input-ting the city name or to the address listscreen.

7. Input a city name.

8. Select the button of the desired cityname from the displayed list.

INFORMATIONYou can search for a street name us-ing just the body.Example : S WESTERN AVEYou can input “S WESTERN AVE”,“WESTERN AVE” or “WESTERN”

Page 75: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

75

There are 4 ways to search by Points of In-terest.(a) Search by name(b) Search by category(c) Search by phone #(d) Search by eDestination

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Point of Interest” on the“Destination” screen.

U2001LS

4. Select the button for the desiredmethod.

(a) Search by “Name”1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Destination”.2. Select “Point of Interest” on the“Destination” screen.3. Select “Name” on the “Point of In-terest” screen.

4. Input the name of the Point of Inter-est.

5. Select the button of the desired des-tination.The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

When inputting the name of a specificPoint of Interest, and there are two or moresites with the same name, the list screenis displayed.

INFORMATIONTo search for a facility name usingmultiple search words, put a spacebetween each word.

— Destination search by“Point of Interest”

Page 76: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

76

Select the button of the desired des-tination.If the same name exists in more than onecity, a search can be performed more easi-ly with “City” and “Category”. (See “�Selecting a city to search” on page 76 and“� Selecting from the categories” on page77.)

INFORMATIONThe desired Point of Interest can bedisplayed on the map screen. (See“ — Display POI icons” on page 108.)

� Selecting a city to search

1. Select “City”.

2. Input the city name.

3. Select the button of the desired cityname from the displayed list.

INFORMATIONTo cancel the city setting, select “AnyCity”.

Page 77: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

77

� Selecting from the categories

Select “Category”.

If the desired POI category is on thescreen, select the name to display a de-tailed list of the POI category.

If the desired POI category is not on thescreen, select “List All Categories” to listall POI categories.

When the desired category is selected, thePOI name list screen is displayed.

(b) Search by “Category”The destination can be set by selecting thesearch point and the POI category.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Destination”.2. Select “Point of Interest” on the“Destination” screen.3. Select “Category” on the “Point ofInterest” screen.

Set the search point by the followingmethod:1. Set the search point from near the ve-

hicle’s current position2. Set the search point from along the

chosen route3. Set the search point from near a city

center4. Set the search point from near a des-

tination

It is possible to display the names of POIslocated within approximately 200 miles(320 km) from the selected search point.

Page 78: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

78

SETTING THE SEARCH POINT FROMNEAR HERESelect “Near Here”.The search point is set at the current posi-tion, and the “POI Category” screen will bedisplayed. (See page 80.)

SETTING THE SEARCH POINT FROMALONG MY ROUTESelect “Along My Route”.The search point is set and the “POI Cate-gory” screen will be displayed. (See page80.)

SETTING THE SEARCH POINT FROMNEAR CITY CENTER1. Select “Near City Center”.

2. Input the city center name.

3. Select the button of the desired citycenter name.The search point is set and the “POI Cate-gory” screen will be displayed. (See page80.)

Page 79: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

79

SELECTING FROM THE LAST 5 CITIES1. Select “Near City Center”.

2. Select “Last 5 Cities”.

3. Select the button of the desired citycenter name.The search point is set and the “POI Cate-gory” screen will be displayed. (See page80.)

SETTING THE SEARCH POINT FROMNEAR A DESTINATION1. Select “Near a Destination”.

2. Select the button of the desired des-tination.The search point is set and the “POIName” screen will be displayed. (Seepage 80.)

Page 80: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

80

� To search POIs near the searchpoint

When the search point is set, the “POICategory” screen will be displayed.

Select the desired POI category.If the desired POI category is not on thescreen, select “List All Categories” to listall POI categories.

Select the desired POI category fromthe list.

By selecting the button of the desired item,the screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

(c) Search by “Phone #”1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Destination”.2. Select “Point of Interest” on the“Destination” screen.3. Select “Phone #” on the “Point of In-terest” screen.

4. Input a telephone number.5. After inputting a telephone number,select “OK”.The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

If there is more than one site with the samenumber, the following screen will be dis-played.

Page 81: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

81

INFORMATION� If there is no match for the tele-

phone number inputted, a list ofidentical numbers with differentarea codes will be displayed.

� To set an address book entry as adestination using the phone num-ber, the number must already beregistered. (See page 127.)

(d) Search by “eDestination”1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Destination”.2. Select “Point of Interest” on the“Destination” screen.3. Select “eDestination” on the “Pointof Interest” screen.

U2002LS

With the eDestination feature, you can goonline, via the Lexus.com owner’s Website, to select and organize destinations ofyour choice and then wirelessly send themto your vehicle’s navigation system. Youcan store up to 200 locations online to ac-cess and update at any time. Your loca-tions can be organized into up to 20 fold-ers. (See “eDestination” on page 166.)

Page 82: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

82

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Destination Assist” on the“Destination” screen.4. Select “Call Dest. Assist” on the“Destination Assist” screen.

U2003LS

Destination Assist provides you with liveassistance for finding destinations via theLexus Enform response center. You canrequest either a specific business,address, or ask for help locating yourdesired destination by category, such asrestaurants, gas stations, shoppingcenters or other points of interest (POI).After you tell the agent your choice ofdestination, its coordinates are sentwirelessly to your vehicle’s navigationsystem. (See “Destination Assist” on page163.)

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Previous Destinations” onthe “Destination” screen.

The previous starting point and up to 100previously set destinations are displayedon the screen.

4. Select the button of the desired des-tination.“Delete”: To delete the previous destina-tion. (To delete previous destinations, seepage 133.)

The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

INFORMATIONThe list of previous destinations canalso be deleted by selecting “DeletePrevious Dest.” on the “NavigationSettings” screen when the vehicle isstopped. (See “ — Deleting previousdestinations” on page 133.)

— Destination search by“Destination Assist”

— Destination search by“Previous Destinations”

Page 83: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

83

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Address Book” on the “Des-tination” screen.A list of registered address book entries isdisplayed.

4. Select the button of the desired ad-dress book entry.“Options”: To register or edit addressbook. (See page 122.)

The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Emergency” on the secondpage of the “Destination” screen.The display changes to a screen to selectpolice stations, dealers, hospitals or firestations. While driving, only nearby policestations, dealers, hospitals, or fire stationsare shown. The current position is shownwith an address, and the latitude and thelongitude at the top of the screen.

4. Select the desired emergency cate-gory.The selected emergency category list isdisplayed.

— Destination search by“Address Book”

— Destination search by“Emergency”

Page 84: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

84

5. Select the button of the desired des-tination.The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

INFORMATIONThe navigation system does notguide in areas where route guidanceis unavailable. (See page 427.)

There are 2 ways to search.(a) Search by intersection(b) Search by Freeway Entrance/Exit

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Intersection & Freeway” onthe second page of the “Destination”screen.

4. Select the button for the desiredmethod.

— Destination search by“Intersection & Freeway”

Page 85: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

85

(a) Search by “Intersection”1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Destination”.2. Select “Intersection & Freeway” onthe second page of the “Destination”screen.3. Select “Intersection” on the “Inter-section & Freeway” screen.

4. Input the name of the first intersect-ing street which are located near thedestination to be set.5. Select “OK”.

6. Select the button of the desireditem.

7. Input the name of the second inter-secting street.

8. Select the button of the desireditem.After inputting the two intersecting streets,the screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

Page 86: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

86

If the same two streets cross at more thanone intersection, the screen changes anddisplays the menu to select the city namewhere the streets intersect. Select the city,and the map location of the selected des-tination and the route preference. (See“Starting route guidance” on page 89.)

(b) Search by “Freeway Entrance/Exit”1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Destination”.2. Select “Intersection & Freeway” onthe second page of the “Destination”screen.3. Select “Freeway Entrance/Exit” onthe “Intersection & Freeway” screen.

4. To input a freeway name.Be sure to use the complete name of thefreeway or highway, including the hyphen,when entering the destination. Freewaysand interstates use an “I” (I−405). US high-ways use the state designation before thenumber (CA−118).

5. Select the desired freeway by se-lecting the button.

Page 87: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

87

6. Either a freeway “Entrance” or“Exit” can be selected.

7. To input a freeway entrance or exitname.8. Select “OK”.

9. Select the button of the desired en-trance or exit name.The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination and theroute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Map” on the second page ofthe “Destination” screen.

The screen changes and displays the maplocation that was previously displayed justbefore the destination input operation andthe route preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

INFORMATIONGuidance starts if “OK” is selectedeven while driving. However, the cur-sor cannot be moved.

— Destination search by“Map”

Page 88: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

88

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Coordinates” on the secondpage of the “Destination” screen.

4. Input the latitude and the longitude.5. When the input is finished, select“OK”.By selecting the button of the desiredpoint, the screen changes and displays themap location of the selected destinationand the route preference. (See “Startingroute guidance” on page 89.)

A set destination can be deleted.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Destination” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Del. Dest.” on the “Destina-tion” screen.When more than one destination is set, alist will be displayed on the screen.

4. Select the destination for deletion.“Select All”: To select all destinations onthe list.

“Unselect All”: To unselect all of the se-lected destinations.

5. Select “Delete”.

— Destination search by“Coordinates” — Deleting set destinations

Page 89: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

89

A message appears to confirm the requestto delete.

6. To delete the destination(s), select“Yes”.If “Yes” is selected, the data cannot be re-covered.

If “No” is selected, the previous screenwill return.

The system searches for the guidanceroute again, and displays the entire route.

INFORMATIONSet destinations can also be deletedby selecting “Route”. (See “ — Delet-ing destinations” on page 101.)

After inputting the destination, the screenchanges and displays the map location ofthe selected destination and the route pref-erence.

1. Scroll the map to the desired point.“Adjust Location”: To adjust the positionin smaller increments.

When an arrow facing the desired pointis selected, the map scrolls in that di-rection.The scroll stops when the selection of thearrow is released.

2. Select “Go to ”.

The system starts route search and dis-plays recommended routes.

If there is already a set destination, “Go to” and “Add to Route” are displayed.

“Go to ”: To delete the existing destina-tions and set a new one.

“Add to Route”: To add a destination.

“Info.”: If this button is displayed on thetop of the screen, select it to view itemssuch as name, address, and phone num-ber.

Starting route guidance

Page 90: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

90

1 Current position2 Destination point3 Type of the route and the distance4 Distance of the entire route

3. To start guidance, select “OK”.“Turn List”: The following screen displaysthe list of the roads up to the destination.

“3 Routes”: To select the desired routefrom 3 possible routes. (See page 91.)

“Edit Route”: To change the route. (Seepage 92.)

INFORMATION� Guidance can be paused or re-

sumed. (See “— Pausing and re-suming guidance” on page 107.)

� If “OK” is selected until a beepsounds, demo mode will start.Push the “MAP/VOICE” button onthe Remote Touch to finish Demomode.

� The route for returning may not bethe same as that for going.

� The route guidance to the destina-tion may not be the shortest routenor a route without traffic conges-tion.

� Route guidance may not be avail-able if there is no road data for thespecified location.

� When setting the destination on amap with a scale larger than 0.5miles (800 m), the map scalechanges to 0.5 miles (800 m) auto-matically. Set the destinationagain.

� If a destination is entered, the roadnearest to the point you selected isset as the destination.

CAUTIONBe sure to obey traffic regulationsand keep road conditions in mindwhile driving. If a traffic sign on theroad has been changed, the routeguidance may not indicate suchchanged information.

Page 91: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

91

3 ROUTES SELECTION

1. To select the desired route from 3routes, select “3 Routes”.

2. Select “Quick”, “Alt.” or “Short” toselect the desired route.“Quick”: Recommended route. This route is indicated by an orange line.

“Alt.”: Alternative route.This route is indicated by a purple line.

“Short”: A route by which you can reachthe destination in the shortest distance.This route is indicated by a green line.

“Info.”: To display the following informa-tion about each of the 3 routes.

1 Time necessary for the entire trip2 Distance of the entire trip3 Toll road4 Freeway5 Ferry

Page 92: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: DESTINATION SEARCH

92

� Edit routeYou can again designate the conditions ofthe route to the destination.

Select “Edit Route”.

“Add”: To add destinations. (See page100.)

“Delete”: To delete destinations. (Seepage 101.)

“Reorder”: To reorder destinations. (Seepage 100.)

“Preferences”: A number of choices areprovided on the conditions which the sys-tem uses to determine the route to the des-tination. (See page 105.)

INFORMATION� Even if the “Freeways” indicator is

dimmed, the route cannot avoid in-cluding a freeway in some cases.

� If the calculated route includes atrip by ferry, the route guidanceshows a sea route. After you travelby ferry, the current vehicle posi-tion may be incorrect. Upon recep-tion of GPS signals, it is automati-cally corrected.

Page 93: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 3

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

93

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

� Route guidance screen 94. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Typical voice guidance prompts 97. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Distance and time to destination 99. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Setting and deleting destinations 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adding destinations 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reordering destinations 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting destinations 101. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Setting route 102. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Detour setting 102. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route overview 103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route preference 105. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pausing and resuming guidance 107. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Show on map 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Display POI∗ icons 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route trace 112. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

∗: Point of Interest

Page 94: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

94

During route guidance, various types ofguidance screens can be displayed de-pending on conditions.

� Screen layout

1 Distance to the next turn and thearrow indicating turning direction

2 Current street name3 Distance and travel/arrival time to

the destination4 Current position5 Guidance route

INFORMATION� If the vehicle goes off the guidance

route, the route is searched again.

� For some areas, the roads have notbeen completely digitized in ourdatabase. For this reason, theroute guidance may select roadthat should not be traveled on.

� When you arrive at your destina-tion, the destination name will bedisplayed on the top of the screen.Selecting “Off” clears the display.

� When the head−up display is on,turn−by−turn guidance arrows willbe displayed on the windshield.

� During freeway drivingDuring freeway driving, the freeway exit in-formation screen will be displayed.

This screen displays the distance to thenext junction and exit, or POIs in the vicin-ity of the freeway exit.

1 Current position2 Points of Interest that are close to

a freeway exit3 Exit number and junction name4 Distance from the current position

to the exit or junction5 Current street name

“Map”: To display the selected map of theexit vicinity.

: To scroll for farther junctions or exits.

: To scroll for closer junctions or exits.

: To scroll for the closest 3 junctions or

exits.

Route guidance screen

Page 95: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

95

� When approaching a freeway exit orjunction

When the vehicle approaches an exit orjunction, the guidance screen for the free-way will be displayed.

1 Next street name2 Distance from the current position

to the exit or junction3 Current position

“Off”: The guidance screen on freewaydisappears and the map screen appears.

When selecting or push-ing the “MAP/VOICE” button on the Re-mote Touch, the guidance screen on free-way reappears.

� When approaching an intersectionWhen the vehicle approaches an intersec-tion, the intersection guidance screen willbe displayed.

1 Next street name2 Distance to the intersection3 Current position

“Off”: The intersection guidance screendisappears and the map screen appears.

When selecting or push-ing the “MAP/VOICE” button on the Re-mote Touch, the intersection guidancescreen reappears.

Page 96: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

96

� Other screensTURN LIST SCREENOn this screen, the list of turns on the guid-ance route can be viewed.

Selecting during guid-ance displays the turn list.

1 Next street name or destinationname

2 Turn direction3 Distance between turns4 Current street name

ARROW SCREENOn this screen, information about nextturns on the guidance route can be viewed.

Selecting during guid-ance displays the arrow screen.

1 Exit number, street name contain-ing number or next street name

2 Turn direction3 Distance to the next turn4 Current street name

Page 97: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

97

The voice guidance provides various mes-sages as you approach an intersection, orother point where you need to maneuverthe vehicle.

4.7 miles

0.5 miles

1 “Proceed about 5 miles to Mainstreet.”

2 “In half of a mile, right turn ontoMain street.”

3 “Right turn.”

4 (Beep sound only)

INFORMATION� The street names may not be pro-

nounced correctly or clearly due totext−to−speech function.

� On freeways, interstates or otherhighways with higher speed limits,the voice guidance will be made atearlier points than on city streets inorder to allow time to maneuver.

4.2 miles

0.5 miles

1 “Proceed about 4 miles to thetraffic circle.”

2 “In half of a mile, traffic circleahead, and then 3rd exit aheadonto Main street.”

3 “The 3rd exit ahead.”

4 “The exit ahead.”

5 (Beep sound only)

Typical voice guidanceprompts

Page 98: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

98

One−way road

One−way road

∗: The system indicates a U−turn if the dis-tance between two one−way roads (of op-posite directions) is less than 50 feet (15m) in residential areas or 164 feet (50 m)in non−residential areas.

1 “In half of a mile, make a legalU−turn.”

2 “Make a legal U−turn ahead.”

3 (Beep sound only)

The system announces the approach tothe final destination.

1 “Your destination is ahead.”

2 “You have arrived at your des-tination. The route guidance isnow finished.”

INFORMATION� If the system cannot determine the

current vehicle position correctly(in cases of poor GPS signal recep-tion), the voice guidance may bemade early or delayed.

� If you did not hear the voice guid-ance command, push the “MAP/VOICE” button on the RemoteTouch to hear it again.

� To adjust the voice guidance vol-ume, see “� Voice volume” onpage 357.

Page 99: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

99

When the vehicle is on the guidance route,the distance and the estimated travel/arriv-al time to the destination are displayed.When the vehicle is not on the guidanceroute, the distance and the direction of thedestination are displayed.

When driving on the guidance route andmore than one destination is set, the dis-tance and the estimated travel/arrival timefrom the current position to each destina-tion are displayed.

1. Select this button to display the fol-lowing screen.

2. Select the number button to displaythe desired destination.

The distance, the estimated travel timeand the estimated arrival time from the cur-rent position to the selected destinationare displayed.

Estimated travel time is dis-played.

Estimated arrival time is dis-played.

To switch to estimated arrivaltime.

To switch to estimated traveltime.

Displayed while driving off theguidance route. The destina-tion direction is indicated byan arrow.

INFORMATIONWhen the vehicle is on the guidanceroute, the distance measured alongthe route is displayed. Travel timeand arrival time is calculated basedon the set vehicle speed information.(See page 361.) However, when thevehicle is not on the guidance route,the distance is the linear distance be-tween the current position and thedestination.

Distance and time todestination

Page 100: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

100

You can add destinations and searchagain for the routes.

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Add”.3. Input an additional destination inthe same way as the destinationsearch. (See “Destination search” onpage 68.)

4. Select the desired “Add DestinationHere” to determine the arrival order ofthe additional destination.

When more than one destination is set,you can change the arrival order of thedestinations.

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Reorder”.

3. Select the desired destination andselect “Move Up” or “Move Down” tochange the arrival order.4. Select “OK”.5. After selecting the destinations, se-lect “OK”.The system searches for the guidanceroute again, and displays the entire route.

Setting and deletingdestinations —— Adding destinations — Reordering destinations

Page 101: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

101

A set destination can be deleted.

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Delete”.When more than one destination is set, alist will be displayed on the screen.

3. Select the destination for deletion.“Select All”: To select all destinations onthe list.

“Unselect All”: To unselect all of the se-lected destinations.

A message appears to confirm the requestto delete.

4. To delete the destination(s), select“Yes”.If “Yes” is selected, the data cannot be re-covered.

If “No” is selected, the previous screenwill return.

The system searches for the guidanceroute again, and displays the entire route.

— Deleting destinations

Page 102: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

102

While the route guidance is operating, youcan change the route to detour around asection of the route where a delay iscaused by road repairs, or an accident,etc.

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Detour”.

3. Select the button below to select thedesired detour distance.“1 mile (km)”, “3 miles (km)” or “5 miles(km)”: Select one of these buttons to startthe detour process. After detouring, thesystem returns to the original guidanceroute.

“Whole Route”: By selecting this button,the system will calculate an entire newroute to the destination.

“Around Traffic”: If you select this button,the system will search for the route basedon the traffic congestion information re-ceived from XM� NavTraffic. For details,see “XM� NavTraffic” on page 179.

Setting route —— Detour setting

Page 103: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

103

This picture shows an example of how thesystem would guide around a delaycaused by a traffic jam.1 This position indicates the location of

a traffic jam caused by road repairs oran accident.

2 This route indicates the detour sug-gested by the system.

INFORMATION� When your vehicle is on a freeway,

the detour distance selections are5, 15, and 25 miles (km).

� The system may not be able to cal-culate a detour route depending onthe selected distance and sur-rounding road conditions.

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Overview”.

The entire route from the current positionto the destination is displayed.

“OK”: To start guidance.

“Turn List”: The following screen displaysthe list of the roads up to the destination.

“Preview”: To preview the route.

— Route overview

Page 104: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

104

You can scroll through the list of roads by

selecting or . However, not all

road names in the route may appear on thelist. If a road changes its name without re-quiring a turn (such as on a street that runsthrough two or more cities), the namechange will not appear on the list. Thestreet names will be displayed in orderfrom the starting point, along with the dis-tance to the next turn.

These marks indicate thedirection in which you shouldturn at an intersection.

Select “Map” on the “Turn List” screen.The point which you choose is displayedon the map screen.

� Route preview

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Overview”.

3. Select “Preview”.

Page 105: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

105

: To indicate the next destination.

: To preview the route to the nextdestination.

: To preview the route to the nextdestination in fast−forward mode.

: To stop the preview.

: To review the route to the previousdestination or starting point.

: To review the route to the previousdestination or starting point infast−forward mode.

: To indicate the previous destina-tion or starting point.

� To select route typeYou can designate the route conditions ofthe route to the destination.

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Preferences”.

3. Select “Quick”, “Short” or “Alter-nate” and select “OK”.

— Route preference

Page 106: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

106

The entire route from the starting point tothe destination is displayed.

“OK”: To start guidance.

“Edit Route”: To change a route. (Seepage 92.)

� To select route featuresA number of choices are provided on theconditions which the system uses to deter-mine the route to the destination.

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Preferences” to change theconditions that determine the route tothe destination.

3. Select the desired route preferenceby selecting the button.When searching for a route, the system willavoid routes when the indicator is off.

4. After choosing the desired routepreference, select “OK”.

Page 107: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

107

� Starting route from adjacent roadYou can start the route guidance from theadjacent road.

(ex. When route guidance is set on thefreeway, but the vehicle is driven parallelalong the freeway.)

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Preferences”.

3. Select “Start from Adjacent Road”.When there is no adjacent road, this buttonwill not be displayed.

� To pause guidance

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Pause Guidance”.

INFORMATIONWithout route guidance, “PauseGuidance” cannot be used.

The screen will return to the current posi-tion map without route guidance.

— Pausing and resumingguidance

Page 108: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

108

� To resume guidance

1. Select “Route”.

2. Select “Resume Guidance”.

The screen will change to the current posi-tion map with route guidance.

Points of Interest such as gas stations andrestaurants can be displayed on the mapscreen. You can also set their location asa destination and use them for route guid-ance.

1. Select “Show on Map”.

2. Select “Select POI” to display a par-ticular type of Point of Interest on thescreen.When the Points of Interest to be displayedon the map screen have already been set,“Change POI” is displayed.

A screen with a limited choice of Points ofInterest will be displayed. (To change thedisplayed POI, see page 364.)

Show on map —— Display POI icons

Page 109: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

109

� Selecting POIs to be displayedUp to 5 categories of icons can be dis-played on the screen.

Select the desired Point of Interestcategory to display POI location sym-bols on the map screen.By selecting the desired POI category andthen selecting “OK”, the selected POIicons are displayed on the map screen.

To turn off the Points of Interest icons onthe map screen, select “Clear”.

“Other POIs”: If the desired Point of Inter-est can not be found on the limited choicescreen, select this button.

“Find Local POI”: When searching for thenearest Point of Interest, select this button.Then choose one of the categories. Thesystem will list the points within 200 miles(320 km). (See page 110.)

Select “Other POIs” on the “Select POIIcons” screen.When a Point of Interest category is se-lected from either the limited list or thecomplete list, the screen will display sym-bols of those locations on the map screen.

Select the desired POI categories.

The selected category icon appears on thetop left of the screen.

By selecting the desired POI category andthen selecting “OK”, the selected POIicons are displayed on the map screen.

If the desired POI category is not on thescreen, select “List All Categories” to listall POI categories.

Page 110: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

110

Select the desired POI categories fromthe list.

The selected category icon appears on thetop left of the screen.

By selecting the desired POI category andthen selecting “OK”, the selected POIicons are displayed on the map screen.

To return to the POI category selectionscreen, select “More”.

� To display the local POI listPoints of Interest that are within 200 miles(320 km) of the current position will belisted from among the selected categories.

1. Select “Find Local POI” on the “Se-lect POI Icons” screen.

2. Select the button of the desiredPoint of Interest.The selected Points of Interest are dis-played on the map screen.

“Near...”: To search for Points of Interestnear the current position or along theroute.

Page 111: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

111

“Near Here” : When “Near Here” is se-lected, the list of Points of Interest near thecurrent position will be displayed.

“Along My Route” : When “Along MyRoute” is selected, the list of Points of In-terest along the route will be displayed.

� To set a POI as a destinationYou can select one of the Points of Interesticons on the map screen as a destinationand use it for route guidance.

1. Directly select the Point of Interesticon that you want to set as a destina-tion.The map will shift so that the icon is cen-tered on the screen and overlaps with thecursor . At this time, the distance fromthe current position is displayed on thescreen. The distance shown is measuredas a straight line from the current vehicleposition to the POI.

2. When the desired Point of Interestoverlaps with the cursor, select “Enter

”.The screen changes and displays the maplocation of the selected destination androute preference. (See “Starting routeguidance” on page 89.)

Page 112: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

112

� To hide POI icons

1. Select “Show on Map”.

2. Select “POI Icons”.The “POI Icons” indicator is dimmed.

The map screen will be displayed with thePOI icons hidden.

To display the POI icons again, select “POIIcons” on the “Show on Map” screen.

It is possible to store the traveled route upto 124 miles (200 km) and retrace the routeon the display.

INFORMATIONThis feature is available on the mapwith more detailed map scale than 30mile (50 km).

— Route trace

Page 113: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

113

� To start recording the route trace

1. Select “Show on Map”.

2. Select “Route Trace”. “Route Trace” indicator is highlighted.

� To stop recording the route trace

1. Select “Show on Map”.

2. Select “Route Trace”. The followingscreen will be displayed.

Selecting “Yes” stops recording and theroute trace remains displayed on thescreen.

Selecting “No” stops recording and theroute trace is erased.

Page 114: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: ROUTE GUIDANCE

114

Page 115: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 4

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

115

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

� Navigation settings 116. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up the “Home” 117. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up the “Preset Destinations” 119. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up the “Address Book” 122. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up the “Areas to Avoid” 128. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting previous destinations 133. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 116: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

116

Points or areas on the map can be regis-tered.

The registered points can be used on the“Destination” screen. (See “ — Destinationsearch by Home” on page 70, “ — Destina-tion search by Preset destinations” onpage 70 and “ — Destination search by“Address Book”” on page 83.)

Registered areas are avoided at the time ofroute search.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U4001LS

2. Select “Setup”.

U4002LS

3. Select “Navi.”.

On this screen, the following operationscan be performed.

No. Function

1 Sets home(See page 117.)

2 Sets preset destinations(See page 119.)

3 Sets address book(See page 122.)

4 Sets area to avoid(See page 128.)

5 Deletes previous destinations(See page 133.)

6 Detailed navigation settings(See page 359.)

Navigation settings —

Page 117: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

117

If home has been registered, that informa-tion can be recalled by using “Go Home”on the “Destination” screen. (See “— Des-tination search by Home” on page 70.)

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2. Select “Setup” on the “Start”screen.

3. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

4. Select “Home”.

� Registering home (See page 117.)

� Editing home (See page 118.)

� Deleting home (See page 119.)

(a) Registering home1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Home” on the “NavigationSettings” screen.

4. Select “Set Home”.

5. Enter the location in the same wayas for a destination search. (See “Des-tination search” on page 68.)

— Setting up the “Home”

Page 118: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

118

When registration of home is completed,the “Edit Home” screen will be displayed.

6. Select “OK”.

To edit registered information, see “(b)Editing home” on page 118.

(b) Editing home1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Home” on the “NavigationSettings” screen.

4. Select “Edit”.

5. Select “Edit” for the item you want tochange.“Name”: To edit home name. The namescan be displayed on the map. (See page126.)

“Location”: To edit location information.(See page 127.)

“Phone #”: To edit telephone numbers.(See page 127.)

“Icon”: To select icons to be displayed onthe map. (See page 125.)

6. Select “OK”.

Page 119: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

119

(c) Deleting home1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Home” on the “NavigationSettings” screen.

4. Select “Delete”.

5. To delete home, select “Yes”. Tocancel the deletion, select “No”.

If preset destination has been registered,that information can be recalled by using“Preset Destinations” on the “Destina-tion” screen. (See “— Destination searchby Preset Destinations” on page 70.)

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2. Select “Setup” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

4. Select “Preset Destinations”.

� Registering preset destination (Seepage 120.)

� Editing preset destination (See page121.)

� Deleting preset destination (Seepage 122.)

— Setting up the “PresetDestinations”

Page 120: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

120

(a) Registering preset destinations1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Preset Destinations” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Set”.

5. Enter the location in the same wayas for a destination search. (See “Des-tination search” on page 68.)

6. Select a position for this preset des-tination.

When registration of preset destination iscompleted, the “Edit Preset Destination”screen will be displayed.

7. Select “OK”.To edit registered information, see “(b)Editing preset destinations” on page 121.

Page 121: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

121

(b) Editing preset destinations1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Preset Destinations” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Edit”.

5. Select the button of the desired pre-set destination.

6. Select “Edit” for the item you want tochange.

“Name”: To edit preset destination names.The names can be displayed on the map. (See page 126.)

“Location”: To edit location information.(See page 127.)

“Phone #”: To edit telephone numbers.(See page 127.)

“Icon”: To select icons to be displayed onthe map. (See page 125.)

7. Select “OK”.

Page 122: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

122

(c) Deleting preset destinations1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Preset Destinations” on the“Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Delete”.

5. Select the preset destination fordeletion.“Select All”: To select all preset destina-tions on the list.

“Unselect All”: To unselect all of the se-lected preset destinations.

6. Select “Delete”.7. To delete preset destination, select“Yes”. To cancel the deletion, select“No”.

Points or areas on the map can be regis-tered.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2. Select “Setup” on the “Start”screen.

3. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

4. Select “Address Book”.

� Registering address book entries(See page 123.)

� Editing address book entries (Seepage 124.)

� Deleting address book entries (Seepage 128.)

— Setting up the “AddressBook”

Page 123: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

123

(a) Registering address book entries1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Address Book” on the “Nav-igation Settings” screen.

4. Select “New”.

5. Enter the location in the same wayas for a destination search. (See “Des-tination search” on page 68.)

After the address book entry has been reg-istered, the “Edit Address Book Entry”screen will be displayed.

6. Select “OK”.

To edit registered information, see “(b)Editing address book entries” on page124.

INFORMATIONUp to 100 address book entries canbe registered.

Page 124: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

124

(b) Editing address book entriesThe icon, name, location and/or telephonenumber of a registered address book entrycan be edited.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Address Book” on the “Nav-igation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Edit”.

5. Select the button of the desired ad-dress book entry.

6. Select “Edit” for the item you want tochange.

“Name”: To edit address book entrynames. The names can be displayed onthe map. (See page 126.)

“Location”: To edit location information.(See page 127.)

“Phone #”: To edit telephone numbers.(See page 127.)

“Icon”: To select icons to be displayed onthe map. (See page 125.)

7. Select “OK”.

Page 125: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

125

� To change “Icon”

1. Select “Edit” of “Icon”.

2. Select the desired icon.

Change pages by selecting “Page 1”,“Page 2” or “With Sound” tab.

SOUND ICONSYou can set a sound for some addressbook entries. When the vehicle ap-proaches the location of the address bookentry, the selected sound will be heard.

1. Select “With Sound” on the “Ad-dress Book Entry Icon” screen.

2. Select the desired sound icon.

The next screen appears when “Bell (withDirection)” is selected.

Select either or to adjust the

direction. Select “OK”.

The bell sounds only when the vehicle ap-proaches this point in the direction that hasbeen set.

Page 126: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

126

� To change “Name”

1. Select “Edit” of “Name”.

2. Enter the name using the alphanu-meric keys.

Up to 32 characters can be entered.

3. Select “OK”.

The previous screen will be displayed.

DISPLAYING MEMORY POINT NAMESThe name of an address book entry can beset to display on the map.

To show the name, select “On” on the“Edit Address Book Entry” screen. Tonot show it, select “Off”.

Page 127: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

127

� To change “Location”

1. Select “Edit” of “Location”.

2. Select one of the 8 directional but-tons to move the cursor to the de-sired point on the map.

3. Select “OK”.

The previous screen will be displayed.

� To change “Phone #” (telephonenumber)

1. Select “Edit” of “Phone #”.

2. Enter the number using numberkeys.

3. Select “OK”.

The previous screen will be displayed.

Page 128: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

128

(c) Deleting address book entries1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Address Book” on the “Nav-igation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Delete”.

5. Select the button to be deleted.

“Select All”: To select all addresses in theaddress book.

“Unselect All”: To unselect all of the se-lected addresses.

6. Select “Delete”.

7. To delete the address book entry, se-lect “Yes”. To cancel the deletion, se-lect “No”.

Areas you want to avoid because of trafficjams, construction work or other reasonscan be registered as areas to avoid.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2. Select “Setup” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

4. Select “Areas to Avoid”.

� Registering areas to avoid (Seepage 129.)

� Editing areas to avoid (See page130.)

� Deleting areas to avoid (See page133.)

— Setting up the “Areas toAvoid”

Page 129: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

129

(a) Registering areas to avoid1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Areas to Avoid” on the “Nav-igation Settings” screen.

4. Select “New”.

5. Enter the location in the same wayas for a destination search, or displaythe map of the area to be avoided. (See“Destination search” on page 68.)

6. Scroll the map to the desired point.

“Adjust Location”: To adjust the positionin smaller increments.

7. Select “Enter”.

8. Select either or to

change the size of the area to beavoided.

9. Select “OK”.

INFORMATION� If a destination is input in the area

to avoid or the route calculationcannot be made without runningthrough the area to avoid, a routepassing through the area to beavoided may be shown.

� Up to 10 locations can be regis-tered as points/areas to avoid.

Page 130: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

130

(b) Editing area to avoidThe name, location and/or area size of aregistered area can be edited.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.

2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Areas to Avoid” on the “Nav-igation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Edit”.

5. Select the desired area button.

6. Select “Edit” for the item you want tochange.

“Name”: To edit the name of the area toavoid. The names can be displayed on themap. (See page 131.)

“Location”: To edit area location. (Seepage 132.)

“Size”: To edit area size. (See page 132.)

“Active”: To turn on or off the area to avoidfeature. To turn on the feature select “On”on the “Edit Area to Avoid” screen. To turnoff the feature select “Off” on the “EditArea to Avoid” screen.

7. Select “OK”.

Page 131: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

131

� To change “Name”

1. Select “Edit” of “Name”.

2. Enter the name using alphanumerickeys.

Up to 32 characters can be entered.

3. Select “OK”.

The previous screen will be displayed.

DISPLAYING NAMES OF AREAS TO BEAVOIDED

The name of an area to be avoided thatmay be displayed on the map can be set.

To show the name, select “On” on the“Area to Avoid” screen. To not show it,select “Off”.

Page 132: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

132

� To change “Location”

1. Select “Edit” of “Location”.

2. Select the 8 directional button tomove the cursor to the desired pointon the map.

3. Select “OK”.

The previous screen will be displayed.

� To change “Size”

1. Select “Edit” of “Size”.

2. Select either or to

change the size of the area to beavoided.

3. Select “OK”.

The previous screen will be displayed.

Page 133: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

133

(c) Deleting areas to avoid1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Areas to Avoid” on the “Nav-igation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Delete”.

5. Select the button to be deleted.

“Select All”: To select all registered areasto avoid in the system.

“Unselect All”: To unselect all registeredareas to avoid in the system.

6. Select “Delete”.

7. To delete the area, select “Yes”. Tocancel the deletion, select “No”.

The previous destination can be deleted.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2. Select “Setup” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.

4. Select “Delete Previous Dest.”.

5. Select the button you want to delete.“Select All”: To select all previous des-tinations in the system.

“Unselect All”: To unselect all previousdestinations in the system.

6. Select “Delete”.

— Deleting previousdestinations

Page 134: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

NAVIGATION SYSTEM: MEMORY POINTS

134

7. To delete the destination, select“Yes”. To cancel the deletion, select“No”.

Page 135: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 5

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

135

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

� Telephone (Hands−free system for cellular phone) 136. . . . . . Enter a Bluetooth� phone 140. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call on the Bluetooth� phone 145. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Receive on the Bluetooth� phone 152. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Talk on the Bluetooth� phone 152. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Fuel consumption 155. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Past record 156. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Consumption 157. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Calendar 158. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 136: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

136

Hands−free system allows you to makeor receive a call without taking yourhands off the steering wheel by con-necting your cellular phone.

This system supports Bluetooth�.Bluetooth� is a wireless data system bywhich you can call without your cellularphone being connected with a cable orplaced on a cradle.

If your cellular phone does not supportBluetooth�, this system can not function.

The operating procedure of the phone isexplained here.

For registering and setting of the phone,see “Telephone settings” on page 368.

CAUTIONWhile driving, do not use a cellularphone or connect the Bluetooth�phone.

NOTICE

Do not leave your cellular phone inthe car. The temperature inside maybe high and damage the phone.

INFORMATION� In the following conditions, the sys-

tem may not function.� The cellular phone is turned off.

� The current position is outsidethe communication area.

� The cellular phone is not connec-ted.

� The cellular phone has a low bat-tery.

� Even if your cellular phone sup-ports both hands−free and audioBluetooth� connections, it maynot be able to connect to thehands−free connection at the

same time.

� When using Bluetooth� audio andhands−free at the same time, the

following problems may occur.

� The Bluetooth� connection maybe cut.

� Noise may be heard on theBluetooth� audio playback.

Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

Telephone(Hands−free system forcellular phone) —

Page 137: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

137

INFORMATIONThis system supports the followingservice.

� Bluetooth� SpecificationVer.1.1 or higher(Recommended: Ver.2.0+EDR orhigher)

� Profiles

� HFP (Hands Free Profile)Ver.1.0 or higher(Recommended: Ver.1.5 or high-er)

� OPP (Object Push Profile) Ver.1.1

� PBAP (Phone Book Access Pro-file) Ver.1.0

If your cellular phone does notsupport HFP, you cannot register theBluetooth� phone, or use OPP orPBAP profiles individually.

Please go to “http://www.lexus.com/”to find approved Bluetooth� phonesfor this system.

By pushing the telephone switch above,you can receive a call or hang up withouttaking your hands off the steering wheel.

� Microphone

You can use the microphone abovewhen talking on the phone.The other party’s voice outputs from thefront speaker. When the received calls orreceived voice outputs, the audio from theaudio system or voice guidance from thenavigation system will be muted.

Page 138: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

138

INFORMATION� Talk alternately with the other party

on the phone. If you talk at thesame time, the voice may notreach each other. (It is not a mal-

function.)

� Keep call volume down. Otherwise,the other party’s voice may be au-dible outside the vehicle andvoice echo may increase. Whenyou talk on the phone, speakclearly towards the microphone.

� In the following situations, yourvoice may not reach the other

party.

� Driving on unpaved road. (Mak-ing a traffic noise.)

� Driving at the high speed.

� The window is open.

� Turning the air−conditioningvents towards the microphone.

� The sound of the air−condition-ing fan is loud.

� There is an effect from the net-work of the cellular phone.

1 Indicates the condition ofBluetooth� connection.

“Blue” indicates an excellent connectionto Bluetooth�.

“Yellow” indicates a bad connection toBluetooth�, resulting in possible deteriora-tion of voice quality.

: No connection to Bluetooth�.

2 Indicates the amount of batterycharge left.

Empty Full

This is not displayed when the Bluetooth�is not connected.

The amount left does not always corre-spond with the one of your cellular phone.The amount of battery charge left may notbe displayed depending on the phone youhave. This system doesn’t have a charg-ing function.3 Indicates the receiving area.

“Rm” is displayed when receiving inRoaming area.

“Hm” is displayed when receiving inHome area.

The receiving area may not be displayeddepending on the phone you have.

Page 139: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

139

4 Indicates the level of reception.

Poor Excellent

The level of reception does not always cor-respond with the one of your cellularphone.

The level of reception may not be dis-played depending on the phone you have.

When you are out of the service area or ina place inaccessible by radio waves, “NoService” is displayed.

An antenna for the Bluetooth� connec-tion is built in the instrument panel. Theindication of the Bluetooth� connectionmay turn yellow and the system maynot function when you use the Blue-tooth� phone in the following condi-tions and places.

� Your cellular phone is obstructed bycertain objects (such as when it isbehind the seat or in the glove box andconsole box).

� Your cellular phone touches or iscovered with metal materials.

Leave the Bluetooth� phone in a placewhere “Blue” indication is displayed.

About the phonebook in this systemThe following data is stored for every regis-tered phone. When another phone is con-necting, you cannot read the registereddata.

� Phonebook data

� Voice tag

� All of call history

� Speed dial

When you delete the phone, theabove−mentioned data is also deleted.

When you release your car:

A lot of personal data is registeredwhen you use the Hands−free system.When you release your car, initializeyour data. (See “� Delete personaldata” on page 352.)

Once initialized, the data and settings willbe erased. Pay much attention when ini-tializing the data.

You can initialize the following data in thesystem.

� Phonebook data

� Call history data

� Speed dial data

� Voice tag data

� Bluetooth� phone data

� Volume setting

� Details setting

Page 140: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

140

FCC ID : AJDK021IC : 775E−K021

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules and RSS−Gen andRSS−210 of IC Rules. Operation is sub-ject to the following two conditions : (1)This device may not cause harmful inter-ference, and (2) this device must acceptany interference received, including in-terference that may cause undesiredoperation.

CAUTIONFCC WARNING: Changes or modifi-cations not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compliancecould void the user’s authority to op-erate the equipment.

CAUTION: Radio Frequency Radi-ation ExposureThis equipment complies with FCCradiation exposure limits set forth foruncontrolled equipment and meetsthe FCC radio frequency (RF) Expo-sure Guidelines in Supplement C toOET65. This equipment has very lowlevels of RF energy that it deemed tocomply without maximum permis-sive exposure evaluation (MPE). Butit is desirable that it should beinstalled and operated with at least 20cm and more between the radiatorand person’s body (excluding ex-tremities: hands, wrists, feet andankles).

Co−location: This transmitter mustnot be co−located or operated in con-junction with any other antenna ortransmitter.

To use the hands−free system, youneed to enter your phone into the sys-tem. Once you have registered it, youcan make a hands−free call.

If you haven’t yet registered anyBluetooth� phones, you must first registeryour phone according to the followingprocedure.

Please see “� Registering a Bluetooth�phone” on page 371 of additional registra-tion when registering.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U5001LS

2. Select “Info./Phone”.

— Enter a Bluetooth� phone

Page 141: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

141

U5002LS

3. Select “Phone”.

4. Select “Yes” to connect your phone.

5. When this screen is displayed, inputthe passcode displayed on the screeninto the phone.For the operation of the phone, see themanual that comes with your cellularphone.

If you want to cancel it, select “Cancel”.

6. When the connection is completed,this screen is displayed.

You do not need to enter the phone in caseof using the same one.

When this screen is displayed, follow theguidance on the screen to try again.

Page 142: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

142

� Connecting a Bluetooth� phoneAUTOMATICALLY

When you register your phone, autoconnection will be turned on. Alwaysset it to this mode and leave theBluetooth� phone in a condition whereconnection can be established.

When the “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode, a nearby cellularphone you have registered is searchedfor.

Next, the system automatically con-nects with the latest of the phones con-nected to in the past.Then, the connection result is dis-played.This screen appears when the Bluetooth�phone is first connected after the “POW-ER” <“ENGINE START STOP”> switch isin ACCESSORY or ON <IGNITION ON>mode.

INFORMATIONIt may take time if the phone connec-tion is carried out during Bluetooth�audio playback.

Page 143: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

143

MANUALLYWhen the auto connection has failed or“Handsfree Power” is turned off, youhave to connect Bluetooth� manually.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.

2. Select “Phone”.

3. Select “Connect Phone”.

4. Select “Handsfree Power”, or selectthe phone to connect.

5. The “Connect Bluetooth*” screen isdisplayed.

6. When the connection is completed,this screen is displayed.Now you can use the Bluetooth� phone.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

Page 144: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

144

When you connect the phone whileBluetooth� audio is playing

This screen is displayed, and theBluetooth� audio will stop temporarily.

� Reconnecting the Bluetooth�phone

If the Bluetooth� phone isdisconnected with a poor receptionfrom the Bluetooth� network when the“POWER” <“ENGINE START STOP”>switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode, the systemautomatically reconnects theBluetooth� phone. In this case, theconnection result is not displayed.

If the Bluetooth� is disconnected on pur-pose such as you turned your cellularphone off, this does not happen. Recon-nect it by the following methods.

� Select the Bluetooth� phone again.

� Enter the Bluetooth� phone.

Page 145: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

145

After you enter the Bluetooth� phone,you can call by using hands−free sys-tem. You can call using the 6 methodsdescribed below.

� By dial

You can call by inputting the phonenumber.

This cannot be operated while driving.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Info./Phone” on the “Start”screen.

You can also push of the steeringwheel to display the “Phone” screen.

U5002LS

3. Select “Phone”.

4. Select the desired key to input thephone number.

Each time you select , an inputted

digit is deleted.

When you select “Redial”, the numberyou called last is inputted.

Select or push of the steering

wheel.

— Call on the Bluetooth�phone

Page 146: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

146

� By phonebookYou can call by phonebook data whichis transferred from your cellular phone.The phonebook changes dependent onthe phone connected. You can registerup to 1000 numbers in each phone-book.

This cannot be operated while driving.

1. Select “Contacts”.

2. Select the desired data from the list.

3. Select the desired number from thelist.

Select or push of the steering

wheel.

Page 147: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

147

When the phonebook is empty

1. Select “Contacts”.

2. Select “Yes” if you want to transfernew contacts from a cellular phone.

Select “No” if you want to edit thephonebook.

� By speed dialYou can call using registered phonenumbers which can be selected from aphonebook. (See “� Registering thespeed dial” on page 389 for registeringthe speed dial.)

This can be done while driving.

1. Select “Speed Dials”.

2. Select the desired number to call.

You can change the page by selecting“Speed Dial 2” or “Speed Dial 3” tab.

Page 148: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

148

� By call historyYou can call by call history which has 4functions below.“All”: all numbers (missed, incom-

ing or outgoing)

“Missed”: calls which you missed

“Incoming”: calls which you received

“Outgoing”: numbers which you called

You can call using the latest 5 call historyitems shown by “All” while driving.

1. Select “Call History”.

2. Select the desired data from the list.

When the list is switched, select “All”,“Missed”, “Incoming” or “Outgoing” tab.

3. Select or push of the steer-

ing wheel.

Page 149: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

149

You can call using the latest call historyitem.

1. Push of the steering wheel to dis-play the “Phone” screen.

2. Push of the steering wheel to dis-play the “Call History” screen.

3. Push of the steering wheel to se-lect the latest history item.

4. Select or push of the steer-

ing wheel to call the latest history item.

� When you call by phonebook, thename (if registered) is displayed.

� When you call the same numbercontinuously, only the newest numberis registered.

� When a phone number registered inthe phonebook is received, the nameand the number are displayed.

� Number−withheld calls are also mem-orized in the system.

� International phone calls may not bemade depending on the cellular phonewhich you have.

� By voice recognition

You can call by giving a command. (Forthe operation and command of voicerecognition, see “Voice command sys-tem” on page 50.)

This can be operated while driving.

The “Dial by Name” operating procedure isexplained here.

Other operating procedures are also simi-lar.

Page 150: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

150

DIALING BY NAMEYou can call by giving a voice tag regis-tered in the phonebook. For setting thevoice recognition, see “—Setting thevoice tag” on page 396.When you select “English” of “Language”,you can call by giving a name registered inthe phonebook.

For setting the voice recognition, see “�Registering the phonebook data” on page382.

Example: Call MIKE.

You: Push the talk switch.

System: “After the beep, please say a command.” “Such as “Go Home”, “Destination”,

“Phone”,“Audio”, “Information” or

“Com mand List”.”“(beep)”

You: “Phone.”

System: “Phone.” “Say a command.” “Such as“Dial by Number”, “Dial by Name”, “Redial”, “Call Back” or “Connect Phone”.” “(beep)”

You: “Dial by Name.”

System: “Dial by Name.” “Say a namefrom your contact list.” “(beep)”

Page 151: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

151

You: “MIKE.”

System: “MIKE.” “Say the type of number.” “Such as “Mobile”, “Home”, “Work” or “Other”.” “(beep)”

You: “Home.”

System: “MIKE.” “Home.”“Push the off−hook switch todial or say “Dial”.”“(beep)”

You: “Dial.”

System: “Dial.”

Now, you can call MIKE.

Calling without the voice recognition

After the entry number is displayed, youcan also call by pushing of the steeringwheel or selecting “Dial”.

Cancelling the voice recognition

The voice recognition will be cancelledwhen you do the following.

� Keep on pushing the talk switch.

� Push of the steering wheel.

� Select “Cancel”. (Except for recogniz-ing the command.)

� Say “Cancel”.

� By POI* call

You can call by selecting when it is

displayed on the screen from naviga-tion system. (See “POI INFORMATION”on page 42 for details.)*: Point of Interest

Page 152: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

152

When a call is received, this screen isdisplayed with a sound. Select or

push of the steering wheel to talk onthe phone.To refuse to receive the call:

Select or push of the steeringwheel.

To adjust the volume of received call:Select “–” or “+” or use the volumeswitch of the steering wheel.

During international phone calls, the otherparty’s name may not be displayed cor-rectly depending on the cellular phonewhich you have.

While you are talking on the phone, thisscreen is displayed. You can do the op-eration below on the screen.

To adjust the volume of the other party’svoice:

Select “–” or “+” or use the volumeswitch of the steering wheel.

To hang up the phone:

Select or push of the steeringwheel.

To mute your voice:Select “Mute”.

To input a Key:Select “0−9”.

To transfer the call:Select “Call Transfer”.

You cannot change from Hands−free callto cellular phone call while driving.

When you change from cellular phone callto Hands−free call, the Hands−free screenwill be displayed and you can operate it onthe screen.

Transferring method and behavior are dif-ferent depending on the cellular phonewhich you have.

For the operation of the phone, see themanual that comes with your cellularphone.

— Receive on theBluetooth� phone

— Talk on the Bluetooth�phone

Page 153: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

153

When you select “0−9”

Select the desired number to input thekey.

To hang up the phone:

Select or push of the steeringwheel.

This cannot be operated while driving.

If the continuous tone signal is regis-tered in a phonebook, this screen ap-pears. (If not registered, “Send” and“Exit” are not displayed.)

Confirm the number displayed on thescreen and select “Send”. The numberbefore marked sign will be sent.

When you select “Exit”, this function willbe finished and normal tone screen ap-pears.

To hang up the phone:

Select or push of the steeringwheel.

The continuous tone signal is the markedsign (p or w) and the number followingphone number. (ex. 056133w0123p#1�)

You can do this operation when you wantto operate an answering machine or use atelephone service in bank for example.You can register the phone number andthe code number in the phonebook.

Page 154: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

154

� By voice recognition

You can operate “Mute” and “SendTones” by giving a command during acall.The operating procedure is similar to othervoice recognition. (For the operation ofvoice recognition, see “Voice commandsystem” on page 50.)

� Incoming call waiting

When the call is interrupted by a thirdparty while talking, this screen is dis-played.

Select or push of the steering

wheel to start talking with the other party.

Select or push of the steeringwheel to refuse the call.

Page 155: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

155

Everytime you select or push of

the steering wheel while interrupt call, theother party will be switched.

If your cellular phone is not accepted forHFP Ver. 1.5, this function can not be used.

INFORMATIONInterrupt call operation may differdepending on your phone companyand cellular phone.

Fuel consumption such as shown be-low can be displayed on the screen. Fordetails see Section 1−1 of the vehicleowner’s manual.

� Energy monitor

� Consumption� Past record

Fuel consumption (vehicleswith hybrid system)

Page 156: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

156

Fuel consumption information from recentresets will be displayed.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U5001LS

2. Select “Info./Phone”.

3. Select “Fuel Consumption”.

If the “Past Record” screen does not ap-pear, select “Past Record”.

“Past Record” screen will be displayed.1 Fuel economy since the last reset2 Current fuel economy3 Best recorded fuel economy

The average fuel consumption history isdivided by color into past averages and theaverage fuel consumption since the lastreset. Use the displayed average fuel con-sumption as a reference.

Reset the average fuel consumption tomeasure the current fuel consumptionagain. For more information on resettingfuel consumption, see the vehicle owner’smanual.

Past record data can be deleted by select-ing “Clear”.

Fuel consumption (vehicleswith gasoline engine) —— Past record

Page 157: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

157

The average fuel consumption of the last30 minutes will be shown in one−minuteblocks.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)

2. Select “Info./Phone” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Fuel Consumption” onthe“Information” screen.

If the “Consumption” screen does not ap-pear, select “Consumption”.

“Consumption” screen will be displayed.1 Fuel consumption in the past 30 min-

utes2 Cruising range

Average fuel consumption is divided bycolor into past averages and averages at-tained since the “ENGINE START STOP”switch was last turned to IGNITION ONmode. Use the displayed average fuelconsumption as a reference.

Consumption data can be deleted by se-lecting “Clear”.

— Consumption

Page 158: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

TELEPHONE AND INFORMATION

158

To view calendar.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U5001LS

2. Select “Info./Phone”.

U5003LS

3. Select “Calendar”.

On this screen, the current date is high-lighted in yellow.

or : To change month.

or : To change year.

“Today”: To display the current month cal-endar (if another month will be displayed).

Calendar

Page 159: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 6

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

159

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETYCONNECT

� Lexus Enform with Safety Connect−Overview 160. . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Destination Assist 163. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� eDestination 166. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� XM� Sports and Stocks 170. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� XM NavWeather� 175. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� XM� NavTraffic 179. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Lexus Insider 182. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 160: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

160

Lexus Enform and Safety Connect aresubscription−based telematics servicesthat use Global Positioning System (GPS)data, embedded cellular technology andXM� satellite data services to providesafety and security as well as conveniencefeatures to subscribers.

Lexus Enform and Safety Connect ser-vices are supported by Lexus’ designatedresponse center, which operates 24 hoursper day, 7 days per week.

Lexus Enform service is available by sub-scription on select, telematics hardware−equipped vehicles.

With an active Lexus Enform subscription,the following features are available:

� Safety Connect features (See yourvehicle Owner’s Manual, Section 3 fordetails.)

� Automatic collision notification∗1

� Stolen vehicle location

� Emergency assistance button(SOS)

� Enhanced roadside assistance

� Destination Assist (see page 163)

� eDestination (see page 166)

� XM� Sports and Stocks∗2 (see page170)

� XM NavWeather�∗3 (see page 175)

� XM� NavTraffic∗3 (see page 179)

The following navigation−based LexusEnform features are available without asubscription:

� Lexus Insider (see page 182)

� Voice Command (see page 50)

∗1: U.S. Patent No. 7,508,298 B2∗2: Available at no extra charge with an ac-

tive XM� satellite radio subscription.∗3: Available via separate XM� subscrip-

tion(s).

Lexus Enform with SafetyConnect−Overview

Page 161: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

161

� SubscriptionAfter you have signed the Telematics Sub-scription Service Agreement and are en-rolled, you can begin receiving services. Avariety of subscription terms is availablefor purchase. Contact your Lexus dealer,call 1−800−25−LEXUS (1−800−255−3987), or select the “Destination Assist”(see page 163) in your vehicle for furthersubscription details.

XM� NavTraffic and XM NavWeather� re-quire separate XM� subscription(s). XM�Sports and Stocks is available with an XM�Satellite Radio subscription. After a90−day free trial, you must set up the ap-propriate XM� subscription(s) to continuereceiving these services.

� Availability of service(s)Lexus Enform premium services Destina-tion Assist and eDestination will function inthe contiguous United States. These ser-vices may also function in Hawaii and limit-ed areas of Alaska for vehicles that containmap data for those states. They will notfunction in Canada or in other countriesoutside the United States.

Lexus Insider and XM� services will func-tion in the contiguous 48 states andCanada. They will not function in Hawaii,Alaska, or countries outside of the U.S oth-er than Canada.

The XM� NavTraffic, XM NavWeather�,and XM� Sports and Stocks services areavailable in the contiguous 48 U.S. statesand Canada. For details about the XM�service coverage areas, refer towww.siriusxm.com or call XM� ListenerCare Center at 1−877−515−3987.

� Activation of service(s)Enrollment in Lexus Enform with SafetyConnect (via your dealership) is requiredto activate all Enform services.

To receive XM� NavTraffic, XM Nav-Weather�, and XM� Sports and Stocksservices, the XM� service must be acti-vated. To activate the service, call the XM�Listener Care Center at 1−877−515−3987.

Customers should have their radio IDready. The radio ID can be found by select-ing “channel 000” on the radio. For details,see “(b) Displaying the radio ID” on page210.

XM� Satellite Radio is responsible for allfees and services, which are subject tochange.

� Certification for Lexus Enform withSafety ConnectFCC ID: O9EGTM1FCC ID: O6Y−CDMRF101NOTEThis device complies with part 15 of theFCC Rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept any interfer-ence received, including interferencethat may cause undesired operation.

FCC WARNINGChanges or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’s au-thority to operate the equipment.

Page 162: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

162

CAUTION

Exposure to radio frequency signals:The Lexus Enform with Safety Con-nect system installed in your vehicleis a low power radio transmitter andreceiver. The system receives andalso sends out radio frequency (RF)signals.In August 1996, the Federal Commu-nications Commission (FCC)adopted RF exposure guidelines withsafety levels for mobile wirelessphones. Those guidelines are con-sistent with the safety standards pre-viously set by both U.S. and interna-tional standards bodies.� ANSI (American National Stan-

dards Institute) C95.1 [1992]� NCRP (National Council on Radi-

ation Protection and Measure-ment) Report 86 [1986]

� ICNIRP (International Commissionon Non−Ionizing Radiation Protec-tion) [1996]

Those standards were based on com-prehensive and periodic evaluationsof the relevant scientific literature.Over 120 scientists, engineers, andphysicians from universities, gov-ernment health agencies, and indus-try reviewed the available body of re-search to develop the ANSI Standard(C95.1).The design of Lexus Enform withSafety Connect complies with theFCC guidelines in addition to thosestandards.

INFORMATION

� Available beginning Fall 2009 onselect Lexus models. Contact withthe Lexus Enform response centeris dependent upon the telematicsdevice being in operative condi-tion, cellular connection availabil-ity, navigation map data, and GPSsatellite signal reception, whichcan limit the ability to reach the re-sponse center or receive support.Enrollment and Telematics Sub-scription Service Agreement re-quired. A variety of subscriptionterms is available; charges vary bysubscription term selected.

� The Lexus Enform response centerwill offer support in multiple lan-guages.

� Select Lexus Enform−subscribedvehicles are capable of communi-cating vehicle information, trigger-ing owner reminder notifications.Owners who do not wish to havetheir vehicle transmit this informa-tion can opt out of the service at thetime of enrollment or by calling1−800−255−3987 and follow theprompt for Safety Connect/LexusEnform.

� For further details about the ser-vice, contact your Lexus dealer.

� Lexus Enform with Safety Connectservices are not subject to section255 of the Telecommunications Actand the device is not TTY compat-ible.

Page 163: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

163

Destination Assist provides you with liveassistance for finding destinations via theLexus Enform response center. You canrequest either a specific business, ad-dress, or ask for help locating your desireddestination by category, such as restau-rants, gas stations, shopping centers orother points of interest (POI).

After you tell the agent your choice of des-tination, its coordinates are sent wirelesslyto your vehicle’s navigation system.

� Make a call with Destination Assist

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U0001LS

2. Select “Destination”.

U12001LS

3. Select “Destination Assist”.“Destination Assist” screen is displayed onthe screen.

Destination Assist

Page 164: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

164

U12002LS

4. Select “Call Dest. Assist” to contactan agent.

U20003LS

5. When an agent comes on the line,tell the agent the address, businessname, or the type of POI or service youwould like to locate.To adjust the call volume, select “−” or “+”on the “Destination Assist” screen, or usethe volume switch on the steering wheelduring the call.

You can end the call at any time by select-ing “Disconnect” on the “Destination As-sist” screen or the steering−wheel phoneon−hook (hang−up) switch.

After the agent helps you determine yourlocation of choice, he or she will place youon hold briefly and wirelessly send the POIto your vehicle’s navigation system. Theagent will then instruct you to either select“Go to ” or “Enter” on the navigationscreen in order to save the destination.The agent will then end the call.

Page 165: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

165

U12040LS

6. Select “Go to ” or “Enter” to setthe location as a destination, receivenavigation guidance via your naviga-tion system and to save the destinationto Destination Assist folder for futurereference.If there is already a set destination, “Go to

” and “Add to Route” are displayed.

“Go to ”: To delete the existing destina-tions and set a new one.

“Add to Route”: To add a destination.

� Destination Assist HistoryLocations you receive via Destination As-sist will be saved to the navigation system.

Up to 100 destinations can be stored in theDestination Assist History.

1. Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.2. Select “Destination Assist” on the“Destination” screen.

U12002LS

3. Select “Dest. Assist History”.

U12004LS

4. Select the desired location in orderto display its data and be able to be setit as a destination.Select “Sort” to sort the locations by eitherdate or name.

Page 166: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

166

DELETE DESTINATION ASSISTHISTORYYou can delete destinations from your his-tory.

U12005LS

1. Select “Delete” on the “DestinationAssist History” screen.

U12006LS

2. Select the individual destinationyou would like to delete or “Select All”.3. Select “Delete”.

With the eDestination feature, you can goonline, via the Lexus.com owner’s Website, to select and organize destinations ofyour choice and then wirelessly send themto your vehicle’s navigation system. Youcan store up to 200 locations online to ac-cess and update at any time.

Your locations can be organized into up to20 personalized folders.

You must first go online at www.lexus.comand go to the “Owners” section where youwill need to register and log in. After this,you can create your personalized folderscontaining the locations you wish to sendto your vehicle. (See Lexus Enform Guidefor more information.)

eDestination

Page 167: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

167

� Download eDestinationsAfter updating your eDestination foldersonline, you will need to download the infor-mation to update the data in the vehicle.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U0001LS

2. Select “Destination”.

U12007LS

3. Select “Point of Interest”.

U12008LS

4. Select “eDestination”.“eDestination” screen is displayed on thescreen.

U12009LS

5. Select “Download”.

U12042LS

6. Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” tocancel download.

Page 168: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

168

U12043LS

When “Yes” is selected, your most recentonline eDestination data will be loaded tothe navigation system.

� Set an eDestination in the naviga-tion system for guidance

1. Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Destina-tion”.2. Select “Point of Interest”.3. Select “eDestination”.

U12009LS

4. Select the desired eDestinationfolder.

U121039LS

5. Select the desired location.

U12040LS

The POI will be shown on the map. You canselect the “Go to ” button to set the POIas a destination with route directions.

You can also select the “Info.” button todisplay more information about the POI.

Page 169: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

169

If there is already a set destination, “Go to” and “Add to Route” are displayed.

“Go to ”: To delete the existing destina-tions and set a new one.

“Add to Route”: To add a destination.

You can also select “Info.” to display moreinformation about the POI.

U12041LS

“Mark”: To mark the POI on the navigationmap.

“Go to ”: To set the POI as a destinationwith route directions.

“Add to Route”: To add the POI as a des-tination.

“Detail”: To read the POI notes you en-tered online, if any.

� Show eDestination icons

1. Select “Show on Map”.

2. Select “eDest. Icons”. “eDest. Icons” indicator is highlighted.

Page 170: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

170

XM� Sports and Stocks is a service in-cluded with XM� satellite radio subscrip-tions for Lexus Enform vehicles. With thisservice, you can receive updates via thenavigation system on your personally se-lected sports teams and stocks.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U5001LS

2. Select “Info./ Phone”.

3. Select “XM Sports” or “XM Stocks”.“XM Sports” or “XM Stocks” screen is dis-played on the screen.

The following operations can be per-formed.

(a) XM Sports� Receive sports information (See

page 171.)

� XM Sports settings (See page 171.)

(b) XM Stocks� Receive stock data (See page 173.)

� XM Stocks settings (See page 174.)

XM� Sports and Stocks

Page 171: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

171

(a) XM SportsYou must first add your desired teams priorto receiving information. (See page 172.)

� Receive sports information1. Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “XM Sports” on the “Informa-tion” screen.

U12024LS

3. Select the desired team for whichyou would like to receive information.Teams for which there is no current dataavailable will be shaded out and you willnot be able to select them.

U12025LS

4. Select the specific information youwould like to receive or select “ReadAll” to receive all available informationfor that team.The selected information will be read in itsentirety.

� XM Sports settings — Add or deleteteams

To input your personalized XM Sportsteam.

1. Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “XM Sports” on the “Informa-tion” screen.

U12026LS

3. Select “Options”.

U12027LS

Please refer to the following pages foreach setting.

You can also input your personalized XMSports team from the “Setup” screen. (See“Other settings” on page 423.)

Page 172: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

172

ADD SPORTS TEAM

U12027LS

1. Select “Add Sports Team”.Up to 5 teams can be added and saved inthe system for which you will receive infor-mation. You can change your teams at anytime. Teams must be added one at a time.

U12028LS

2. Select the sporting league of theteam you would like to enter.

U12029LS

3. Select the name of the team youwould like to add from the list that ap-pears.

U12044LS

4. Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” tocancel.

Page 173: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

173

DELETE SPORTS TEAMS

U12027LS

1. Select “Delete Sports Teams”.

U12031LS

2. Select the sports team that youwould like to delete or select “SelectAll” to delete all teams.3. Select “Delete”.

U12045LS

4. Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” tocancel.

(b) XM StocksYou must first add your desired stocksprior to receiving data. (See page 174.)

� Receive stock data1. Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “XM Stocks” on the “Informa-tion” screen.

U12033LS

3. Select the individual stock for whichyou would like to receive verbal data orselect “Read All”.The available chosen data will be read inits entirety.

Stock data may be delayed by up to 15minutes.

Page 174: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

174

� XM Stocks settings — Add or deletestocks

To input your personalized XM Stocks set-tings.

1. Push the “MENU” button on theRemote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “XM Stocks” on the “Informa-tion” screen.

U12033LS

3. Select “Options”.

U12034LS

Please refer to the following pages foreach setting.

You can also input your personalized XMStocks settings from the “Setup” screen.(See “Other settings” on page 423.)

ADD STOCK

U12034LS

1. Select “Add Stock”.

U12035LS

2. Input the stock symbol you wouldlike to add.3. When finished, select “OK” to enter.You can enter and save up to 10 individualstock symbols for which you would like toreceive data. Stocks must be input one ata time. You must know the symbol of thestock you wish to enter.

Page 175: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

175

DELETE STOCKS

U12034LS

1. Select “Delete Stocks”.

U12037LS

2. Select the stock you would like todelete or select “Select All”.3. Select “Delete”.

U12046LS

4. Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” tocancel.

The subscription−based XM NavWeath-er� service allows the navigation systemto display weather information on the map.

See page 161 for subscription information.

The following operations can be per-formed.

� Show XM NavWeather� informa-tion

Weather forecast information is displayedon the map. (See page 176.)

� Weather informationWeather information for the selected city isdisplayed. (See page 178.)

� Weather warningsWeather warnings issued within anapproximately 15.5 mile (25 km) radiusaround the vehicle are displayed on thewarning screen. (See page 178.)

XM NavWeather�

Page 176: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

176

� Show XM NavWeather� informa-tion

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U5001LS

2. Select “Info./Phone”.

U12038LS

3. Select “XM NavWeather”.“XM NavWeather” screen is displayed onthe screen.

XM NavWeather� SCREEN

1 “Info.” buttonWhen the city icon button is selected, the“Info.” button will be displayed on thescreen. Selecting this button displays the“Forecast” screen. (See page 178.)2 City icon

When this button is selected, city namesand the “Info.” button will be displayed onthe upper part of the screen.3 “Forecast” button

When this button is selected, the cityselection screen will be displayed.

Select a city to display weather informa-tion. Weather information of the selectedcity will be displayed. (See page 178.)4 “Current Location” button

When the “Current Location” button isselected, a map of the vehicle’s currentlocation will be displayed.

Page 177: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

177

5 Zoom in/out buttonThe scale of the map can be changed.Three zoom levels can be selected; 16miles (26 km), 30 miles (48 km) and 60miles (97 km).6 Weather icons and grids

Inclement weather information is dis-played on the map using weather iconsand grids. Selecting an icon shows the re-lated information at the top of the screen.

Icon Weather

Tornado

Hurricane

Storm

Flood

Winter

Wind

Extremes

Other

Hail storm

Shear storm

Heavy fog

Heavy freezing rain/ice

Icon Weather

Heavy snow

Heavy rain

Page 178: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

178

� Weather information

1 Received time2 City name3 Today’s date4 Current weather5 Current temperature6 Today’s weather7 Tomorrow’s weather8 Day after tomorrow’s weather9 Observed time

10 Specified day’s weatherWhen this button is selected, weather in-formation for a specified day will be dis-played.

1 Daytime weather2 Nighttime weather3 Maximum temperature4 Minimum temperature5 Precipitation probability

� Weather warningsWeather warnings issued with in anapproximately 15.5 mile (25 km) radiusaround the vehicle are displayed on thewarning screen.

“Show Map”: When this button is se-lected, the “XM NavWeather” screen willbe displayed.

“OK”: When this button is selected, thescreen will return to the map of the currentlocation.

This severe weather warning will displayagain if the severe weather is within anapproximate 7.8 mile (12.5 km) radiusaround the vehicle.

Page 179: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

179

� XM NavWeather� indicator

When an XM NavWeather� Warning is is-sued within the vicinity, the XM NavWeath-er� indicator will appear on the screen.

The subscription−based XM� NavTrafficservice allows the navigation system todisplay traffic information on the map.

See page161 for subscription information.

The following operations can be per-formed.

� Show XM� NavTraffic InformationTraffic information is displayed on the map.(See page 180.)

� Auto Avoid TrafficIf any heavy congestion or moderate traffichas been detected on the guidance route,it may be possible for you to select anotherroute offered by the system. (See page362.)

� Traffic Voice GuidanceTraffic information is provided using voiceguidance. (See page 358.)

� Show Free Flowing TrafficFreely flowing traffic is shown by the arrowon the map. (See page 363.)

INFORMATION

� Traffic voice guidance is availableonly in English. To select English,see “� Selecting a language” onpage 348.

� When the “Traffic Information” in-dicator is dimmed, “Auto AvoidTraffic”, “Traffic Voice Guidance”and “Show Free Flowing Traffic”will not operate.

XM� NavTraffic

Page 180: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

180

� Show XM� NavTraffic information

1. Select “Show on Map”.

2. Select “Traffic Information”. “Traffic Information” indicator is high-lighted.

XM� NavTraffic information is displayedon the map.

� On Map screen

� On Freeway information screen

Page 181: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

181

1 XM� NavTraffic iconWhen any traffic information has beenreceived, the XM� NavTraffic icon willappear on the map screen. Selecting theXM� NavTraffic icon on the screen willstart voice guidance for the traffic informa-tion. (See page 44.)

INFORMATION

When the XM� NavTraffic icon is se-lected, voice guidance for the trafficinformation will start even if “Off” for“Traffic Voice Guidance” is selected.

2 XM� NavTraffic information arrowWhen any XM� NavTraffic information hasbeen received, the XM� NavTraffic infor-mation arrow will appear on the mapscreen. The color of the arrow changesdepending on the traffic information re-ceived.

“Orange”: Heavy congestion

“Yellow”: Moderate traffic

“Green”: Freely flowing traffic

3 XM� NavTraffic indicatorWhen any XM� NavTraffic information hasbeen received, the XM� NavTraffic indica-tor will appear on the screen. The color ofthe indicator changes depending on thetraffic information received.

“White”: Traffic information has been re-ceived.

“Yellow”: Traffic restriction information onthe guidance route has been received(screen button∗).

“Orange”: Congestion information on theguidance route has been received (screenbutton∗).∗: Selecting the XM� NavTraffic indicator

will start voice guidance.

Page 182: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

182

Lexus Insider is an optional service thatcan send audio messages, or articles, toparticipating owners’ vehicles via the navi-gation system. Potential Lexus Insidersubjects might include, for example, Lexusvehicle technology tips, updates on re-gional Lexus events, or audio excerptsfrom Lexus Magazine articles. Up to 20 ar-ticles can be stored at a time.

You may opt out of receiving Lexus Insidermessages at any time. (See page 185.)

� View and play received Lexus Insid-er messages

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U5001LS

2. Select “Info. / Phone”.

U12011LS

3. Select “LEXUS Insider”.“LEXUS Insider” screen is displayed onthe screen.

Lexus Insider

Page 183: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

183

U12012LS

4. Select the desired article title fromthe Lexus Insider menu to play thatbroadcast or select “Read All” to listento all stored Lexus Insider broadcasts.To disrupt the audio read of Lexus Insider,push the “MODE” switch on the steeringwheel or push the “AM·FM”, “SAT”,“DISC”, “CD” or “AUX·USB” button onthe audio system.

Icons appear at the left of the Lexus Insiderstory titles and indicate the following:

Icon Article

Unread article

Previously read article

Article with downloadablePoint of Interest (POI)

U12013LS

After selecting an individual article, youcan then select “Next Article” or“Previous Article” to listen to anotherarticle.

You can also use the “ ” or “ ” switchon the steering wheel to move to the pre-vious or next article.

Page 184: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

184

Some Lexus Insider stories will contain adownloadable POI relevant to the content.If it contains a POI, you can select “Enter

” to download it to the navigation sys-tem.

U12047LS

You can select the “Go to ” button to setthe POI as a destination with route direc-tions.

DELETE LEXUS INSIDER ARTICLE

U12012LS

1. Select “Delete” on the “LEXUS In-sider” screen.

U12015LS

2. Select the individual article title thatyou would like to delete or “Select All”.3. Select “Delete”.

Page 185: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

185

� New article notificationWhen the vehicle is first powered on and anew Lexus Insider article is available, a no-tification will appear on the navigationscreen.

The notice will appear for only approxi-mately 6 seconds unless you choose oneof the options listed.

U12016LS

When the new article notification appears,you can select any of the following options.

“Listen Now”: Plays newly received Lexus Insider ar-ticle(s).

“Ignore”:Removes notification screen without play-ing new articles.

“Remind Me Later”: Removes notification screen without play-ing articles. Notification will be displayedagain when the vehicle is next powered on.

� Lexus Insider settingsTo change Lexus Insider settings, notifica-tion, and opt in or out of article receipt.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U4001LS

2. Select “Setup”.

U10007LS

3. Select “Other”.

Page 186: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

186

U12017LS

4. Select “LEXUS Insider”.“LEXUS Insider settings” screen is dis-played on the screen.

U12018LS

Please refer to the following pages foreach setting.

RECEIVE/OPT OUT OF LEXUS INSIDER

U12019LS

1. Select “Receive LEXUS Insider”.2. Select “Yes” to receive Lexus Insid-er articles or “No” to opt out of receiv-ing articles.3. Select “Save”.

Page 187: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

187

NEW ARTICLE NOTIFICATIONAutomatic notification of new Lexus Insid-er articles is available and is the defaultsetting.

U12020LS

1. Select “New Article Notification”.2. Select “On” or “Off”.3. Select “Save”.

RESTORE THE DEFAULT LEXUSINSIDER SETTINGS

U12021LS

1. Select “Default”.

U12022LS

2. Select “Yes” to confirm or “No” tocancel.

Page 188: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

LEXUS ENFORM WITH SAFETY CONNECT

188

Page 189: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 7

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

189

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

� Quick reference 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Using your audio/video system 197. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Some basics 197. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Radio operation 205. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Radio operation (XM� Satellite Radio broadcast) 210. . . . . . . . CD changer operation 216. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD changer operation 230. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bluetooth� audio operation 256. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . USB memory/iPod operation 264. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Audio/video remote controls (steering switches) 272. . . . . . . . . . .

� Rear seat entertainment system features 274. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using the radio 280. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using the DVD player 281. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing an audio CD/CD text 281. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing WMA/MP3 discs 282. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing DVD video/audio 282. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using the video mode 295. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing other settings 296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Audio/video system operating hints 298. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 190: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

190

Operations such as selecting a preset station and adjusting the sound balance are car-ried out on the screen. To display the audio screen, push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch and select “Audio”.

�DVD changer (Type A)

�If a Mark Levinson brand audio system is installed, the “Mark Levinson” logois shown on the panel.

1 Function menu tabTo control the radio, DVD changer,Bluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod, select the screentabs. For details, see page 199.

2 Function menu display screenTo control the radio, DVD changer,Bluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod, select the screenbuttons. For details, see page 199.

3 Disc slotInsert discs into the slot after pushing“LOAD” button. For details, seepage 231.

4 “LOAD” buttonPush this button to insert the discs.For details, see page 231.

5 “TUNE·FILE” knobTurn this knob to move the stationband and files up or down. For de-tails, see pages 211, 226 and 269.

Quick reference

Page 191: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

191

6 “SCAN” buttonPush this button to scan radio sta-tions or scan the files or tracks. Fordetails, see pages 207, 212, 223, 228and 270.

7 “CH·DISC” buttonPush the “�” or “�” button to selecta preset station or a selected disc.For details, see page 233.

8 “AUX·USB” buttonPush this button to turn theBluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod on. For details, seepages 199, 205, 256 and 264.

9 “DISC” buttonPush this button to turn the DVDchanger on. For details, see pages199 and 235.

10 “SAT” buttonPush this button to choose a SAT sta-tion. For details, see pages 199 and210.

11 “SEEK·TRACK” buttonPush either side of this button to seekup or down for a station, or to accessa desired track, file or chapter. Fordetails, see pages 207, 212, 222,226, 242, 253, 262 and 268.

12 “AM·FM” buttonPush this button to choose a radiostation. (AM, FM1, FM2) For details, see pages 199 and 205.

13 “PWR·VOL” knobPush this knob to turn the audio sys-tem on and off, and turn it to adjust thevolume. For details, see page 199.

14 “ ” buttonPush this button to eject the discs.For details, see page 233.

Page 192: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

192

�DVD changer (Type B)

�If a Mark Levinson brand audio system is installed, the “Mark Levinson” logois shown on the panel.

1 Function menu tabTo control the radio, DVD changer,Bluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod, select the screentabs. For details, see page 199.

2 Function menu display screenTo control the radio, DVD changer,Bluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod, select the screenbuttons. For details, see page 199.

3 Disc slotInsert discs into the slot after pushing“LOAD” button. For details, seepage 231.

4 “LOAD” buttonPush this button to insert the discs.For details, see page 231.

5 “TUNE·FILE” knobTurn this knob to move the stationband and files up or down. For de-tails, see pages 211, 226 and 269.

6 “SCAN” buttonPush this button to scan radio sta-tions or scan the files or tracks. Fordetails, see pages 207, 212, 223, 228and 270.

7 “CH·DISC” buttonPush the “�” or “�” button to selecta preset station or a selected disc.For details, see page 233.

Page 193: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

193

8 “AUX” buttonPush this button to turn theBluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod on. For details, seepages 199, 205, 256 and 264.

9 “DISC” buttonPush this button to turn the DVDchanger on. For details, see pages199 and 235.

10 “FM” buttonPush this button to choose an FM sta-tion. For details, see pages 199 and205.

11 “SEEK·TRACK” buttonPush either side of this button to seekup or down for a station, or to accessa desired track, file or chapter. Fordetails, see pages 207, 212, 222,226, 242, 253, 262 and 268.

12 “AM” buttonPush this button to choose an AM sta-tion. For details, see pages 199 and205.

13 “PWR·VOL” knobPush this knob to turn the audio sys-tem on and off, and turn it to adjust thevolume. For details, see page 199.

14 “ ” buttonPush this button to eject the discs.For details, see page 233.

Page 194: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

194

�CD changer (Type A)

1 Function menu tabTo control the radio, CD changer,Bluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod, select the screentabs. For details, see page 199.

2 Function menu display screenTo control the radio, CD changer,Bluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod, select the screenbuttons. For details, see page 199.

3 Disc slotInsert discs into the slot after pushing“LOAD” button. For details, seepage 216.

4 “LOAD” buttonPush this button to insert the discs.For details, see page 216.

5 “TUNE·FILE” knobTurn this knob to move the stationband and files up or down. For de-tails, see pages 211, 226 and 269.

6 “SCAN” buttonPush this button to scan radio sta-tions or scan the files or tracks. Fordetails, see pages 207, 212, 223, 228and 270.

7 “CH·DISC” buttonPush the “�” or “�” button to selecta preset station or a selected disc.For details, see page 218.

Page 195: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

195

8 “AUX·USB” buttonPush this button to turn theBluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod on. For details, seepages 199, 205, 256 and 264.

9 “CD” buttonPush this button to turn the CDchanger on. For details, see pages199 and 220.

10 “SAT” buttonPush this button to choose a SAT sta-tion. For details, see pages 199 and210.

11 “SEEK·TRACK” buttonPush either side of this button to seekup or down for a station, or to accessa desired track, file or chapter. Fordetails, see pages 207, 212, 222,226, 262 and 268.

12 “AM·FM” buttonPush this button to choose a radiostation. (AM, FM1, FM2) For details, see pages 199 and 205.

13 “PWR·VOL” knobPush this knob to turn the audio sys-tem on and off, and turn it to adjust thevolume. For details, see page 199.

14 “ ” buttonPush this button to eject the discs.For details, see page 218.

Page 196: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

196

�CD changer (Type B)

1 Function menu tabTo control the radio, CD changer,Bluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod, select the screentabs. For details, see page 199.

2 Function menu display screenTo control the radio, CD changer,Bluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod, select the screenbuttons. For details, see page 199.

3 Disc slotInsert discs into the slot after pushing“LOAD” button. For details, seepage 216.

4 “LOAD” buttonPush this button to insert the discs.For details, see page 216.

5 “TUNE·FILE” knobTurn this knob to move the stationband and files up or down. For de-tails, see pages 211, 226 and 269.

6 “SCAN” buttonPush this button to scan radio sta-tions or scan the files or tracks. Fordetails, see pages 207, 212, 223, 228and 270.

7 “CH·DISC” buttonPush the “�” or “�” button to selecta preset station or a selected disc.For details, see page 218.

Page 197: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

197

8 “AUX” buttonPush this button to turn theBluetooth� audio player, AUX, USBmemory or iPod on. For details, seepages 199, 205, 256 and 264.

9 “CD” buttonPush this button to turn the CDchanger on. For details, see pages199 and 220.

10 “FM” buttonPush this button to choose an FM sta-tion. For details, see pages 199 and205.

11 “SEEK·TRACK” buttonPush either side of this button to seekup or down for a station, or to accessa desired track, file or chapter. Fordetails, see pages 207, 212, 222,226, 262 and 268.

12 “AM” buttonPush this button to choose an AM sta-tion. For details, see pages 199 and205.

13 “PWR·VOL” knobPush this knob to turn the audio sys-tem on and off, and turn it to adjust thevolume. For details, see page 199.

14 “ ” buttonPush this button to eject the discs.For details, see page 218.

This section describes some of the basicfeatures of your audio/video system.Some information may not pertain to yoursystem.

Your audio/video system works when the“POWER” <“ENGINE START STOP”>switch is turned to ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode.

FCC ID : AJDK021IC : 775E−K021

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules and RSS−Gen andRSS−210 of IC Rules. Operation is sub-ject to the following two conditions : (1)This device may not cause harmful inter-ference, and (2) this device must acceptany interference received, including in-terference that may cause undesiredoperation.

CAUTION

FCC WARNING: Changes or modifi-cations not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compliancecould void the user’s authority to op-erate the equipment.

CAUTION: Radio Frequency Radi-ation ExposureThis equipment complies with FCCradiation exposure limits set forth foruncontrolled equipment and meetsthe FCC radio frequency (RF) Expo-sure Guidelines in Supplement C toOET65. This equipment has very lowlevels of RF energy that it deemed tocomply without maximum permis-sive exposure evaluation (MPE). Butit is desirable that it should beinstalled and operated with at least 20cm and more between the radiatorand person’s body (excluding ex-tremities: hands, wrists, feet andankles).

Using your audio/videosystem — — Some basics

Page 198: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

198

Co−location: This transmitter mustnot be co−located or operated in con-junction with any other antenna ortransmitter.� Laser products

� Do not take this unit apart or at-tempt to make any changesyourself. This is an intricate unitthat uses a laser pickup to re-trieve information from the sur-face of compact discs. The la-ser is carefully shielded so thatits rays remain inside the cabi-net. Therefore, never try to dis-assemble the player or alter anyof its parts since you may be ex-posed to laser rays and danger-ous voltages.

� This product utilizes a laser.Use of controls or adjustmentsor performance of proceduresother than those specified here-in may result in hazardous radi-ation exposure.

NOTICE

To prevent the 12−volt battery frombeing discharged, do not leave theaudio/video system on longer thannecessary when the hybrid system isoff <the engine is not running>.

(a) Voice command system

By pushing the switch above, you canoperate the voice command system.For the operation of the voice commandsystem and the list of commands, seepages 50 and 54.

Page 199: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

199

(b) Turning the system on and off

“PWR·VOL”: Push this knob to turn theaudio system on and off. Turn this knob toadjust the volume. The system turns on inthe last mode used.

You can select the function that enablesautomatic return to the previous screenfrom the audio screen. See page 346 fordetails.

(c) Switching between functions

� DVD changer (Type A) image

Push the “AM·FM”, “AM”, “FM”, “SAT”,“DISC”, “CD”, “AUX·USB” or “AUX”button to turn on the desired mode.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U6001LS

2. Select “Audio”.

Page 200: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

200

3. Select “AM”, “FM”, “SAT”, “CD”,“CD/DVD”, “BT”, “AUX” or “USB” tabto turn on the desired mode.Push these buttons or tabs if you want toswitch from one mode to another.

If the disc is not set, the CD changer/DVDchanger does not turn on.

You can turn off the CD changer/DVDchanger by ejecting all the discs. If the au-dio system was previously off, then the en-tire audio system will be turned off whenyou eject all the discs.

Page 201: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

201

The screen buttons for radio, CDchanger, DVD changer, Bluetooth� au-dio player, AUX, USB memory and iPodoperation are displayed on the screenwhen the audio control mode is se-lected.Select the tab to select the desired modewhen the audio control mode is selected.

INFORMATIONYou cannot operate dimmed screenbuttons.

Page 202: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

202

(d) DSP control1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Audio”.

2. Select “Sound” to display the soundadjustment screen.

3. Select “DSP” tab to display thisscreen.4. Select the desired button.Surround function:Select “On” of “Surround” and select“OK”.The surround function will turn on.

Automatic sound levelizer (ASL):When the audio sound becomes difficult tohear due to road noise, wind noise or othernoises while driving, select “On”. The sys-tem adjusts to the optimum volume andtone quality according to the speed of car,wind noise or other noise.

(e) Tone and balanceToneHow good an audio program sounds to youis largely determined by the mix of thetreble, mid and bass levels. In fact, differ-ent kinds of music and vocal programsusually sound better with different mixes oftreble, mid and bass.

BalanceA good balance of the left and right stereochannels and of the front and rear soundlevels is also important.

Keep in mind that if you are listening to astereo recording or broadcast, changingthe right/left balance will increase the vol-ume of one group of sounds while de-creasing the volume of another.

Page 203: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

203

1. Select “Sound” tab to display thisscreen.2. Select the desired button.“Treble” “+” or “–”: Adjust high−pitchedtones.

“Mid” “+” or “–”: Adjust mid−pitchedtones.

“Bass” “+” or “–”: Adjusts low−pitchedtones.

“Front” or “Rear”: Adjusts sound bal-ance between the front and rear speakers.

“L” or “R”: Adjusts sound balance be-tween the left and right speakers.

3. Select “OK”.The tone of each mode (for such as AM,FM, CD changer and DVD changer) canbe adjusted.

(f) Selecting screen size (DVD chan-ger only)Before selecting screen size, it is neces-sary to insert a DVD disc and select DVDmode.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Audio”.2. Select “CD/DVD” tab.

3. Select “Settings”.

4. Select “Wide”.

Page 204: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

204

5. Select the desired button.“Normal”: Displays a 3 : 4 screen, with

either side in black.“Wide 1”: Widens the 3 : 4 screen hori-

zontally to fill the screen.“Wide 2”: Widens the 3 : 4 screen ver-

tically and horizontally, in the same ratio, to fill thescreen.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

6. Select “OK”.

(g) Your CD or DVD changerWhen you insert a disc, push the “LOAD”button and gently push the disc in with thelabel side up. This CD or DVD changercan store up to six discs.

The changer is intended for use with 4.7 in.(12 cm) discs only.

NOTICE

� Do not stack up two discs for inser-tion, or it will cause damage to thechanger. Insert only one disc intothe slot at a time.

� Never try to disassemble or oil anypart of the changer. Do not insertanything other than a disc into theslot.

Page 205: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

205

(h) AUX portThe sound of portable audio playersconnected to the AUX port can be enjoyed.Push the “AUX·USB” or “AUX” button todisplay audio screen and select “AUX”tab to switch to AUX mode. When theportable audio player is not connected tothe AUX port, the tab will tone down. Fordetails, refer to the “Owner’s Manual”.

(i) USB portIt is available to connect a USB memory/iPod with the USB port. When the USBmemory/iPod is not connected with theUSB port, the tab will tone down. For de-tails, see “(a) Connecting a USB memoryor iPod” on page 264.

(a) Listening to the radio

Push the “AM·FM”, “AM” or “FM” but-ton to display audio screen and select“AM” or “FM” tab to choose either anAM or FM station.“AM”, “FM1” or “FM2” appears on thescreen.

If your vehicle is equipped with a satelliteradio broadcast system, when you pushthe “SAT” button or select “SAT” tab onaudio screen, “SAT1”, “SAT2”, “SAT3”station appears on the display. For detailsabout satellite radio broadcast, see“—Radio operation (XM� Satellite Radiobroadcast)” on page 210.

— Radio operation

Page 206: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

206

Turn the knob clockwise to step up thestation band or counterclockwise tostep down.Your radio automatically changes to stereoreception when a stereo broadcast is re-ceived. “ST” appears on the screen. If thesignal becomes weak, the radio reducesthe amount of channel separation to pre-vent the weak signal from creating noise.If the signal becomes extremely weak, theradio switches from stereo to mono recep-tion. In this case, “ST” disappears from thescreen.

(b) Presetting a station

1. Tune in the desired station.2. Select one of the buttons (1 — 6) youwant and hold it until a beep is heard.This sets the station to the button andthe frequency appears on the button.Each radio mode (AM, FM1 or FM2) canstore up to 6 stations. To change the pre-set station to a different one, follow thesame procedure.

The preset station memory is cancelledwhen the power source is interrupted by12−volt battery disconnection or a blownfuse.

Page 207: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

207

(c) Selecting a stationTune in the desired station using one of thefollowing methods.

Preset tuning: Select the button (1 — 6)for the station you want. The button ishighlighted and the station frequency ap-pears on the screen.

Seek tuning: Push the “SEEK·TRACK”button on either side. The radio will beginseeking up or down for a station of thenearest frequency and will stop on recep-tion. Each time you push the button, thestations will be searched automaticallyone after another.

To scan all the frequencies: Push the“SCAN” button or select “SCAN” on thescreen briefly. “SCAN” appears on thescreen. The radio will find the next stationand stay there for a few seconds, and thenscan again. To select a station, Push the“SCAN” button or select “SCAN” again.

To scan the preset stations: Push the“SCAN” button or select “SCAN” on thescreen for longer than a second. “P.SCAN” appears on the screen. The radiowill tune in the next preset station, staythere for a few seconds, and then move tothe next preset station. To select a station,push the “SCAN” button or select“SCAN” again.

(d) Radio Data SystemYour audio system is equipped with RadioData Systems (RDS). RDS mode pro-vides you to receive text messages fromradio stations that utilize RDS transmit-ters.

When RDS is on, the radio can— only select stations of a particular pro-gram type,— display messages from radio stations,— search for a stronger signal station.

RDS features are available for use only onFM stations which broadcast RDS infor-mation.

Page 208: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

208

“Type � �”If the system receives no RDS stations,“NO−PTY” appears on the display.

Each time you select “� Type ” or “Type�”, the program type changes as in thefollowing:

� ROCK

� MISC (Miscellaneous)

� INFORM (Information)

� EASY LIS (Easy listening)

� CLS/JAZZ (Classical music and Jazz)

� R & B (Rhythm and Blues)

� RELIGION

� ALART (Emergency message)

“TypeSeek”When a program is set, “Type Seek” ap-pears. Select the button and the systemstarts to seek the station in the relevantprogram type.

If any type program station is not found,“Nothing” appears on the display.

Page 209: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

209

“Message”If the system receives a radio text fromRDS station, “MSG” appears on the dis-play. Select “Message”, and a text mes-sage is displayed on the screen. This func-tion is available only when the vehicle isnot moving.

When you select “Message Off”, the dis-play returns.

(e) Traffic announcement

“Traffic”A station that regularly broadcasts trafficinformation is automatically located.

When you select “Traffic”, “Traf. Seek”appears on the display and the radio willstart seeking any traffic program station.

If no traffic program station is found,“Nothing” appears on the display.

If a traffic program station is found, thename for traffic program station is dis-played for a while until a traffic announce-ment is received.

Page 210: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

210

� Type A only

To listen to a satellite radio broadcast inyour vehicle, a subscription to the XM�Satellite Radio service is necessary.

(a) How to subscribe to an XM� Satel-lite Radio

An XM� Satellite Radio is a tuner designedexclusively to receive broadcasts providedunder a separate subscription. Availabilityis limited to the 48 contiguous U.S. statesand some Canadian provinces.

How to subscribe:You must enter into a separate serviceagreement with the XM� Satellite Radio inorder to receive satellite broadcast pro-gramming in the vehicle. Additional activa-tion and service subscription fees applythat are not included in the purchase priceof the vehicle and optional digital satellitetuner.

For complete information on subscriptionrates and terms, or to subscribe to the XM�Satellite Radio.

U.S.A.—Visit on the web at www.siriusxm.com orcall 1−877−515−3987.

Canada—Visit on the web at www.xmradio.ca or call1−877−438−9677.

The XM� Satellite Radio is solely responsi-ble for the quality, availability and contentof the satellite radio services provided,which are subject to the terms and condi-tions of the XM� Satellite Radio customerservice agreement.

Customers should have their radio IDready; the radio ID can be found by tuningto “channel 000” on the radio. For details,see “(b) Displaying the radio ID” below.

All fees and programming are the respon-sibility of the XM� Satellite Radio and aresubject to change.

Satellite tuner technology notice: Lexus’s satellite radio tuners are awardedType Approval Certificates from XM� Sat-ellite Radio Inc. as proof of compatibilitywith the services offered by the XM� Satel-lite Radio.

(b) Displaying the radio IDEach XM� tuner is identified with a uniqueradio ID. You will need the radio ID whenactivating XM� service or when reportinga problem.

If you select the “CH 000” using the“TUNE·FILE” knob, the ID code of 8 al-phanumeric characters appears. If you se-lect another channel, display of the IDcode is canceled. The channel(000) alter-nates the display between the radio ID andthe specific radio ID code.

INFORMATIONCargo loaded on the roof luggage car-rier, especially metal objects, may ad-versely affect the reception of XM�Satellite Radio.

— Radio operation(XM� Satellite Radiobroadcast)

Page 211: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

211

(c) Listening to satellite radio

Push the “SAT” button to display audioscreen and select “SAT” tab to choosea SAT channel.“SAT1”, “SAT2” or “SAT3” appears on thescreen.

Turn this knob to select the next or pre-vious channel.If you turn continuously, you can rapidlyscroll forward or down through the chan-nels.

(d) Channel category

Select either “� Type” or “Type �” to goto the next or previous category.

Page 212: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

212

(e) Presetting a channel1. Tune in the desired channel.

2. Select one of the channel selectorbuttons (1 — 6) and hold it until a beepis heard.This sets the channels to the button andthe name and number of the channel ap-pears on the button.

Each button can store three SAT channels.To change the preset channel to a differentone, follow the same procedure.

The preset channel memory is cancelledwhen the power source is interrupted by12−volt battery disconnection or a blownfuse.

(f) Selecting a channelTune in the desired channel using one ofthe following methods.

Preset tuning: Select the channel selec-tor button (1 — 6) for the channel you want.The button (1 — 6) is highlighted and chan-nel number appears on the display.

To select channel within the currentcategory: Push the “�” or “�” button of“SEEK·TRACK”. The radio will step up ordown the channel within the current chan-nel category.

To scan the currently selected channelcategory: Select “SCAN” or push the“SCAN” button briefly. “SCAN” appearson the display. The radio will find the nextchannel in the same channel category,stay there for a few seconds, and thenscan again. To select a channel, select“SCAN” or push the “SCAN” button asecond time.

To scan the preset channels: Select“SCAN” or push the “SCAN” button andhold it until you hear a beep. “P.SCAN” ap-pears on the display. The radio will find thenext preset channel, stay there for a fewseconds, and then move to the next presetchannel. To select a channel, select“SCAN” or push the “SCAN” button asecond time.

Page 213: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

213

(g) Displaying the title and name

When you select “Text”, the song/pro-gram title and the artist name/feature aredisplayed.

Up to 16 alphanumeric characters can bedisplayed. (Some information will not befully displayed.)

When you select “Text” again, the displayreturns.

Page 214: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

214

(h) If the satellite radio tuner malfunctionsWhen problems occur with the XM� tuner, a message will appear on the display. Refer-ring to the table below to identify the problem, take the suggested corrective action.

ANTENNA

The XM� antenna is not connected. Check whether theXM� antenna cable is attached securely.

A short circuit occurs in the antenna or the surroundingantenna cable. See a Lexus certified dealer for assis-tance.

UNAUTH

You have not subscribed to the XM� Satellite Radio.The radio is being updated with the latest encryptioncode. Contact the XM� Satellite Radio for subscriptioninformation. When a contract is canceled, you canchoose the “CH000” and all free−to−air channels.

The premium channel you selected is not authorized.Wait for about 2 seconds until the radio returns to theprevious channel or “CH001”. If it does not change au-tomatically, select another channel. If you want to listento the premium channel, contact the XM� Satellite Ra-dio.

NO SIGNALThe XM� signal is too weak at the current location. Waituntil your vehicle reaches a location with a stronger sig-nal.

LOADINGThe unit is acquiring audio or program information. Waituntil the unit has received the information.

OFF AIRThe channel you selected is not broadcasting any pro-gramming. Select another channel.

−−−−−There is no song/program title or artist name/featureassociated with the channel at that time. No actionneeded.

CHUNAVL

The channel you selected is no longer available. Waitfor about 2 seconds until the radio returns to the pre-vious channel or “CH001”. If it does not change auto-matically, select another channel.

Contact the XM� Listener Care Center at 1−877−515−3987 (U.S.A.) or1−877−438−9677 (Canada).

Page 215: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

215

NOTICE

This equipment has been tested andfound to comply with the limits for aclass B digital device, pursuant toPart 15 of the FCC Rules. These limitsare designed to provide reasonableprotection against harmful interfer-ence in a residential installation. Thisequipment generates, uses and canradiate radio frequency energy and, ifnot installed and used in accordancewith the instructions, may causeharmful interference to radio com-munications. However, there is noguarantee that interference will notoccur in a particular installation.

If this equipment does cause harmfulinterference to radio or television re-ception, which can be determined byturning the equipment off and on, theuser is encouraged to try to correctthe interference by one or more of thefollowing measures:

—Reorient or relocate the receivingantenna.

—Increase the separation betweenthe equipment and receiver.

—Connect the equipment into an out-let on a circuit different from that towhich the receiver is connected.

—Consult the dealer or an experi-enced radio/TV technician for help.

Information to user

Alternation or modifications carriedout without appropriate authoriza-tion may invalidate the user’s right tooperate the equipment.

INFORMATIONThis XM� tuner supports “AudioServices” (Music and Talk) of onlyXM� Satellite Radio and “TextInformation”∗ linked to the respective“Audio Services”.∗: Text Information includes, StationName, (Artist) Name, (Song) Title andCategory Name.

Page 216: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

216

(a) Inserting discsThe “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch must be in ACCESSORYor ON <IGNITION ON> mode.

Your CD changer can store up to 6 discs.

You can set a disc at the lowest empty discnumber.

� Setting a single disc:

1. Push the “LOAD” button briefly.The orange indicators at both ends of theslot start blinking. After the orange indica-tors change to green and stay on, the CDchanger door will open.

— CD changer operation

Page 217: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

217

2. Insert only one disc while the CDchanger door is open.You can set a disc at the lowest empty discnumber.

After insertion, the set disc is automaticallyloaded.

If the label faces down, the disc cannot beplayed. In this case, “Check CD” appearson the screen.

If you do not insert the disc within 15 sec-onds after pushing the “LOAD” button, abeep will sound and the operation will becanceled automatically.If you need to insert the next disc, repeatthe same procedure to insert another disc.

� Setting all the discs:

1. Push the “LOAD” button until youhear a beep.The orange indicators at both ends of theslot start blinking. After the orange indica-tors change to green and stay on, the CDchanger door will open.

2. Insert only one disc while the CDchanger door is open.The CD changer door closes and theorange indicators start blinking.

Page 218: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

218

3. Insert the next disc after the orangeindicators change to green and stay onand the CD changer door opens.4. Repeat this procedure until you in-sert all the discs.To cancel the operation, push the “LOAD”button briefly.

If you do not insert the discs within 15 sec-onds after pushing the “LOAD” button, thebeep will sound and the operation will becanceled automatically.

NOTICE

Do not insert one disc stacked on topof another one or feed them in contin-uously, to prevent discs from gettingstuck in the changer.

(b) Ejecting discs� A single disc alone:

1. Push the “ ” or “ ” button of“CH·DISC” or select the disc numberbutton on the “Change Discs” screento highlight the disc number you wantto eject.To display the “Change Discs” screen, se-lect “Change Discs” on each audio con-trol screen.

Page 219: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

219

2. Push the “ ” button for the discbriefly.At this time, the orange indicators of theslot start blinking and the disc is ejected.

3. After the blinking indicators stay on,remove the disc.

� Ejecting all the discs:

1. Push the “ ” button for the discuntil you hear a beep.At this time, the orange indicators of theslot start blinking and a disc is ejected.

2. After the blinking indicators stay on,remove the disc.The indicators start blinking again and thenext disc is ejected.

If you do not remove the disc within 15 sec-onds after it is ejected, the beep will soundand the operation will be canceled auto-matically.

When all the discs are removed, the indi-cators go out.

Page 220: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

220

The numbers of the trays where the disc isnot set are dimmed.

(c) Playing a disc

Push the “CD” button to display audioscreen and select “CD” tab if the discsare already loaded in the changer.The discs set in the changer are playedcontinuously, starting with the last disc youinserted. The disc number of the disc cur-rently being played, the track number andthe time from the beginning of the programappear on the screen.

When play of one disc ends, the first trackof the following disc starts. When play ofthe final disc ends, play of the first discstarts again.

The changer will skip any empty disc trays.

Page 221: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

221

(d) Selecting a desired disc

On the screen:Select “CD” tab and select “ChangeDiscs”The selected disc number is highlighted.

The changer will start playing the selecteddisc from the first track.

On the audio panel:Push the “ ” or “ ” button of“CH·DISC”.When you release the button, the changerwill start playing the selected disc from thefirst track.

(e) Playing an audio disc

Select “CD” tab, then select “ChangeDiscs”. Choose an audio disc numberto display this screen.

Page 222: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

222

SELECTING A DESIRED TRACK

“SEEK·TRACK” button: Use for directaccess to a desired track.

Push either side of the “SEEK·TRACK”button and repeat it until the desired tracknumber appears on the screen. As you re-lease the button, the changer will startplaying the selected track from the begin-ning.

“Select” for Track: The desired track canbe selected from a list. This function isavailable only when the vehicle is not mov-ing.

Select “Select”. The track list is dis-played.

Select the desired track number. Thechanger will start playing the selectedtrack from the beginning.

: By selecting this button, the list

moves up by 5 track groups. If this buttonis selected when the top page of the list isdisplayed, the last page is displayed.

: By selecting this button, the list

moves down by 5 track groups. If this but-ton is selected when the last page of the listis displayed, the top page is displayed.

�, �: If � appears to the right of the itemname, the complete name is too long forthe display.

Select � to scroll to the end of the name.Select � to scroll the beginning of thename.

Fast forward: Push “�” side of the“SEEK·TRACK” button and hold it to fastforward the disc. When you release thebutton, the changer will resume playingfrom that position.

Reverse: Push “�” side of the“SEEK·TRACK” button and hold it to re-verse the disc. When you release the but-ton, the changer will resume playing.

Page 223: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

223

SEARCHING FOR A DESIRED TRACKOR DISC

Searching for a desired track —Select “SCAN” on the screen or pushthe “SCAN” button briefly while thedisc is playing.“SCAN” appears on the screen. Thechanger will play the next track for 10 sec-onds, then scan again. To select a track,select “SCAN” on the screen or push the“SCAN” button a second time. If thechanger reaches the end of the disc, it willcontinue scanning at track 1.

After all the tracks are scanned in onepass, normal play resumes.

Searching for a desired disc —Select “SCAN” on the screen or pushthe “SCAN” button for longer than asecond while the disc is playing.“D.SCAN” appears on the screen. Theprogram at the beginning of each audiodisc will be played for 10 seconds. To con-tinue listening to the program of yourchoice, select “SCAN” on the screen orpush the “SCAN” button a second time.

After all the audio discs are scanned in onepass, normal play resumes.

Page 224: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

224

OTHER FUNCTIONS

“RPT”: Use it for automatic repeat of thetrack or disc you are currently listening to.

Repeating a track —Select “RPT” briefly while the track isplaying. “RPT” appears on the screen.When the track is finished, the changer willautomatically go back to the beginning ofthe track and play the track again. To can-cel it, select “RPT” once again.

Repeating a disc —Select “RPT” for longer than a secondwhile the disc is playing. “D.RPT” appearson the screen. When the disc is finished,the changer will automatically go back tothe beginning of the disc and play the discagain. To cancel it, select “RPT” onceagain.

“RAND”: Use it for automatic and randomselection.

Playing the tracks on one disc in ran-dom order —Select “RAND” briefly while the disc isplaying. “RAND” appears on the screen.The system selects a track on the disc be-ing listened to in random order. To cancelit, select “RAND” once again.

Playing the tracks on all the audio discsin random order —Select “RAND” for longer than a secondwhile the disc is playing. “D.RAND” ap-pears on the screen. The system selectsa track on all the audio discs in the changerin random order. To cancel it, select“RAND” once again.

If a CD−TEXT disc is inserted, the title ofthe disc and track will be displayed. Up to32 letters can be displayed.

Page 225: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

225

(f) Playing a MP3/WMA disc

Select “CD” tab, then select “ChangeDiscs”. Choose an MP3/WMA discnumber to display this screen.

SELECTING A DESIRED FOLDER

“Folder”: Select this button to go to thenext folder.

“Folder”: Select this button to go to theprevious folder.

“Select” for Folder: The desired foldercan be selected in a list. This function isavailable only when the vehicle is not mov-ing.

Select “Select”. The folder list is dis-played.

Select the desired folder number. Thechanger will start playing the first file of theselected folder.

: By selecting this button, the list

moves up by 5 folder groups. If this buttonis selected when the top page of the list isdisplayed, the last page is displayed.

: By selecting this button, the list

moves down by 5 folder groups. If this but-ton is selected when the last page of the listis displayed, the top page is displayed.

Page 226: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

226

SELECTING A DESIRED FILE

“SEEK·TRACK” button: Use for directaccess to a desired file.

Push either side of the “SEEK·TRACK”button and repeat it until the desired filenumber appears on the display. As you re-lease the button, the changer will startplaying the selected file from the begin-ning. When “RAND” or “FLD.RPT” is on,the file number within the folder you arecurrently listening to appears.

Fast forward: Push “�” side of the“SEEK·TRACK” button and hold it to fastforward the disc. When you release thebutton, the changer will resume playingfrom that position.

Reverse: Push “�” side of the“SEEK·TRACK” button and hold it to re-verse the disc. When you release the but-ton, the changer will resume playing.

“TUNE·FILE” knob: Use for direct accessto a desired file in the disc.

Turn the “TUNE·FILE” knob to step up ordown all the files in the disc you are cur-rently listening to. The file number ap-pears on the display. When “RAND” or“FLD.RPT” is on, all the files in the folderyou are currently listening to can bestepped up or down.

Page 227: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

227

“Select” for File: The desired file can beselected in a list. This function is availableonly when the vehicle is not moving.

Select “Select”. The file list is displayed.

Select the desired file number. The chang-er will start playing the selected file fromthe beginning.

: By selecting this button, the list

moves up by 5 file groups. If this button isselected when the top page of the list isdisplayed, the last page is displayed.

: By selecting this button, the list

moves down by 5 file groups. If this buttonis selected when the last page of the list isdisplayed, the top page is displayed.

Page 228: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

228

SEARCHING FOR A DESIRED FILE

Select “SCAN” on the screen or pushthe “SCAN” button briefly while thedisc is playing.“SCAN” appears on the screen. Thechanger will play the next file in the folderfor 10 seconds, then scan again. To selecta file, select “SCAN” on the screen orpush the “SCAN” button a second time.If the changer reaches the end of the fold-er, it will continue scanning from file 1.

After all the files are scanned in one pass,normal play resumes.

SEARCHING FOR A DESIRED FOLDER

Select “SCAN” on the screen or pushthe “SCAN” button for longer than asecond while the disc is playing.“FLD.SCAN” appears on the screen. Theprogram at the beginning of each folder willbe played for 10 seconds. To continue lis-tening to the program of your choice, se-lect “SCAN” on the screen or push the“SCAN” button a second time.

After all the folders are scanned in onepass, normal play resumes.

Page 229: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

229

OTHER FUNCTIONS

“RPT”: Use it for automatic repeat of thefile or folder you are currently listening to.

Repeating a file —Select “RPT” briefly while the file is play-ing. “RPT” appears on the screen. Whenthe file is finished, the changer will auto-matically go back to the beginning of thefile and play the file again. To cancel it, se-lect “RPT” once again.

Repeating a folder —Select “RPT” for longer than a secondwhile the folder is playing. “FLD.RPT” ap-pears on the screen. When the folder isfinished, the changer will automatically goback to the beginning of the folder and playthe folder again. To cancel it, select “RPT”once again.

“RAND”: Use it for automatic and randomselection of the folder or the disc which youare currently listening to.

Playing the files in one folder in randomorder —Select “RAND” briefly while the disc isplaying. “RAND” appears on the screen.The system selects a file in the folder youare currently listening to. To cancel it, se-lect “RAND” once again.

Playing the files in all the folders on onedisc in random order —Select “RAND” for longer than a secondwhile the disc is playing. “FLD.RAND” ap-pears on the screen. The system selectsa file in all the folders. To cancel it, select“RAND” once again.

When a file is skipped or the system is in-operative, select “RAND” to reset.

Page 230: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

230

(g) If the changer malfunctionsIf “CD error” appears on the screen, audiosignals of the disc cannot be read or thesystem has trouble. Push the “CD” buttononce again.

If the changer does not operate, check thatthe disc surface is not soiled or damaged.If the disc is O.K., the temperature of thechanger’s internal mechanism may beraised because of high external tempera-ture. Remove the disc from the changer tocool it.

If the changer still does not operate, haveit checked by your dealer.

If an MP3/WMA disc contains CD−DAfiles, only CD−DA files are played. If anMP3/WMA disc contains files other thanCD−DA, only MP3/WMA files are played.

For safety reasons, you can enjoy DVDvideo discs, DVD audio discs and videoCDs only when the vehicle is completelystopped with the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is in ACCESSORYor ON <IGNITION ON> mode and theparking brake applied. While you are driv-ing, you can hear audio alone even in theDVD video, DVD audio or video CD mode.

— DVD changer operation

Page 231: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

231

(a) Inserting discsThe “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch must be in ACCESSORYor ON <IGNITION ON> mode.

Your DVD changer can store up to 6 discs.

You can set a disc at the lowest empty discnumber.

� Setting a single disc:

1. Push the “LOAD” button briefly.The orange indicators at both ends of theslot start blinking. After the orange indica-tors change to green and stay on, the DVDchanger door will open.

Page 232: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

232

2. Insert only one disc while the DVDchanger door is open.You can set a disc at the lowest empty discnumber.

After insertion, the set disc is automaticallyloaded.

If the label faces down, the disc cannot beplayed. In this case, “Check disc �” ap-pears on the screen.

If you do not insert the disc within 15 sec-onds after pushing the “LOAD” button, abeep will sound and the operation will becanceled automatically.If you need to insert the next disc, repeatthe same procedure to insert another disc.

� Setting all the discs:

1. Push the “LOAD” button until youhear a beep.The orange indicators at both ends of theslot start blinking. After the orange indica-tors change to green and stay on, the DVDchanger door will open.

2. Insert only one disc while the DVDchanger door is open.The DVD changer door closes and theorange indicators start blinking.

Page 233: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

233

3. Insert the next disc after the orangeindicators change to green and stay onand the DVD changer door opens.4. Repeat this procedure until you in-sert all the discs.To cancel the operation, push the “LOAD”button briefly.

If you do not insert the discs within 15 sec-onds after pushing the “LOAD” button, thebeep will sound and the operation will becanceled automatically.

NOTICE

Do not insert one disc stacked on topof another one or feed them in contin-uously, to prevent discs from gettingstuck in the changer.

(b) Ejecting discs� A single disc alone:

1. Push the “ ” or “ ” button of“CH·DISC” or select the disc numberbutton on the “Change Discs” screento highlight the disc number you wantto eject.To display the “Change Discs” screen, se-lect “Change Discs” on each audio con-trol screen.

Page 234: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

234

2. Push the “ ” button for the discbriefly.At this time, the orange indicators of theslot start blinking and the disc is ejected.

3. After the blinking indicators stay on,remove the disc.

� Ejecting all the discs:

1. Push the “ ” button for the discuntil you hear a beep.At this time, the orange indicators of theslot start blinking and a disc is ejected.

2. After the blinking indicators stay on,remove the disc.The indicators start blinking again and thenext disc is ejected.

If you do not remove the disc within 15 sec-onds after it is ejected, the beep will soundand the operation will be canceled auto-matically.

When all the discs are removed, the indi-cators go out.

Page 235: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

235

The numbers of the trays where the disc isnot set are dimmed.

(c) Playing a disc

Push the “DISC” button to display au-dio screen and select “CD/DVD” tab ifthe discs are already loaded in thechanger.The discs set in the changer are playedcontinuously, starting with the last disc youinserted. The disc number of the disc cur-rently being played, the track or title andchapter number and the time from the be-ginning of the program appear on thescreen.

Audio CD only —

When play of one disc ends, the first trackof the following disc starts. When play ofthe final disc ends, play of the first discstarts again.

The changer will skip any empty disc trays.

Page 236: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

236

(d) Selecting a desired disc

On the screen:Select “CD/DVD” tab and select“Change Discs”.The selected disc number is highlighted.

The changer will start playing the selecteddisc from the first track.

On the audio panel:Push the “ ” or “ ” button of“CH·DISC”.When you release the button, the changerwill start playing the selected disc from thefirst track.

(e) Operating a DVD discNOTE: The playback condition of someDVD discs may be determined by a DVDsoftware producer. This DVD changerplays a disc as the software producerintended. So some functions may notwork properly. Be sure to read theinstruction manual for the DVD discseparately provided. For the detailedinformation about DVD video discs, see“(h) DVD player and DVD video discinformation” on page 254.Precautions on DVD video discWhen recording with a DVD video or videoCD, audio tracks may not record in somecases while the menu is displayed. As au-dio will not play in this case, verify that thevideo tracks are playing and then activateplayback.

When playback of a disc is completed:

� If an audio CD or MP3/WMA disc isplaying, the first track or file starts.

� If a DVD video or video CD is playing,playback will stop or the menu screenwill be displayed.

The title/chapter number and playbacktime display may not appear while playingback certain DVD video discs.

Page 237: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

237

CAUTION

Conversational speech on someDVDs is recorded at a low volume toemphasize the impact of sound ef-fects. If you adjust the volume as-suming that the conversations repre-sent the maximum volume level thatthe DVD will play, you may be startledby louder sound effects or when youchange to a different audio source.The louder sounds may have a signif-icant impact on the human body orpose a driving hazard. Keep this inmind when you adjust the volume.

This screen appears when the videoscreen is first displayed after the“POWER” <“ENGINE START STOP”>switch is in ACCESSORY or ON <IGNI-TION ON> mode.

Page 238: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

238

PLAYING A DVD DISC

Select “CD/DVD” tab to display thisscreen.Select “Settings” on “CD/DVD” screenand select “Wide” on “Settings” screen.The screen mode can be changed.

If you select “Full Screen” when the ve-hicle is completely stopped and the park-ing brake is applied, the video screen re-turns.

DVD SETTINGS

� DVD video

� DVD audio

If you select “Settings” on “DVD” screen,“Settings” screen appears.

Page 239: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

239

DESCRIPTION OF DVD VIDEO SET-TINGS“DVD Video Settings”: The initial set upscreen appears. (See page 246.)

“Search”: The title search screen ap-pears. (See page 242.)

“Return”: Selecting this will display thepredetermined scene and start playingfrom there.

“Audio”: The audio changing screen ap-pears. (See page 244.)

“Subtitle”: The subtitle changing screenappears. (See page 244.)

“Angle”: The angle selection screen ap-pears. (See page 245.)

“Wide”: The screen mode screen ap-pears. (See page 203.)

DESCRIPTION OF DVD AUDIO SET-TINGS“DVD Audio Settings”: The initial set upscreen appears. (See page 246.)

“Search”: The group search screen ap-pears.

“Return”: Selecting this will display thepredetermined scene and start playingfrom there.

“Audio”: The audio changing screen ap-pears. (See page 245.)

“Subtitle”: The subtitle changing screenappears. (See page 244.)

“Angle”: The angle selection screen ap-pears. (See page 245.)

“Wide”: The screen mode screen ap-pears. (See page 203.)

“Prev. Page”: Select this button to re-verse the pages. (See page 243.)

“Next Page”: Select this button to forwardthe pages. (See page 243.)

“Select Number”: The track or numbersearch screen appears. (See page 253.)

“RPT”: Select this button to repeat a track.

“RAND”: Select this button to play thetrack in one group in random order.

“SCAN”: Select this button to play thenext track in the group for 10 seconds, thenscan again.

Page 240: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

240

DISPLAYING DVD CONTROLS

� DVD video

� DVD audio

If you select , while watching video,

DVD controls will appear.

If “ ” appears on the screen when you se-lect a control, the operation relevant to thecontrol is not permitted.

DESCRIPTION OF DVD VIDEO CON-TROLS“Menu” and “Top Menu”: If you selectany of the above controls, the menuscreen for DVD video appears. (For theoperation, see the manual that comes withthe DVD video disc provided separately.)

: The menu control key appears on the

screen. (See page 241.)

: Selecting this will pause the video

screen.

: Selecting this will fast reverse dur-

ing playback.

: Selecting this will stop the video

screen.

: Selecting this will resume normal

play during pause.

: Selecting this will fast forward dur-

ing playback and forward frame by frameduring pause.

Page 241: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

241

DESCRIPTION OF DVD AUDIO CON-TROLS“Top Menu”: If you select this button, themenu screen for DVD audio appears. (Forthe operation, see the manual that comeswith the DVD audio disc provided sepa-rately.)

: The menu control key appears on the

screen. (See page 241.)

: Selecting this will pause the disc.

: Selecting this will fast reverse dur-

ing playback.

: Selecting this will stop the disc.

: Selecting this will resume normal

play during pause.

: Selecting this will fast forward dur-

ing playback and forward frame by frameduring pause.

SELECTING A MENU ITEM

Enter the menu item using ,

, and and select“Enter”. The player starts playing discfor that menu item. Menu items canalso be selected using the pointer. (Fordetails, see the manual that comes withthe DVD disc provided separately.)When you select the any point on thescreen, the controls will disappear. To dis-play them again, select the any point onthe screen.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

Page 242: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

242

SEARCHING BY TITLE

DVD video only—

Enter the title number and select “OK”.The player starts playing video for thattitle number.When you push either side of the“SEEK·TRACK” button, you can select achapter.

If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

SEARCHING BY GROUP

DVD audio only —

Enter the group number and select“OK”. The player starts playing thedisc for that group number.When you push either side of the“SEEK·TRACK” button, you can select atrack.

If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

Page 243: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

243

SELECTING THE BONUS GROUPDVD audio only —

Enter the bonus group number on thesearching group screen and select“OK”.The “Enter Key Code” screen will appear.To enter the number of the group you wantto play, select the group number.

If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

Select “OK” on the screen.The player starts playing the disc from theselected bonus group number.

CHANGING THE PAGE

DVD audio only —

Select “Prev. Page” or “Next Page” onthe screen to forward or reverse thepages.

Page 244: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

244

CHANGING THE SUBTITLELANGUAGE

Each time you select “Change”, the lan-guage is selected from the ones storedin the discs and changed.When you select “Hide”, the subtitle canbe hidden.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

CHANGING THE AUDIO LANGUAGE

DVD video only —

Each time you select “Change”, the lan-guage is selected from the ones storedin the discs and changed.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

Page 245: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

245

CHANGING THE AUDIO FORMAT

DVD audio only —

Each time you select “Change”, anoth-er audio format stored on the disc is se-lected.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

CHANGING THE ANGLE

The angle can be selected for discs thatare multi−angle compatible when theangle mark appears on the screen.Each time you select “Change”, theangle is selected from the ones storedin the discs and changed.

When you select , and the previousscreen returns.

Page 246: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

246

SETUP MENU

There are initial setting buttons on the“Setup Menu” screen.After you change the initial setting, select

. The initial setting screen will beturned off and return to the picturepreviously.

When “Default” is selected, all menus areinitialized.

The initial setting can be changed.

� Audio languageYou can change the audio language.1. Select “Audio Language”.2. Select the language you want tohear on the “Audio Language” screen.If you cannot find the language you want tohear on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For the entry oflanguage code, see the following “ENTERAUDIO LANGUAGE CODE”.

To return to the “Setup Menu” screen, se-lect .

� Subtitle languageYou can change the subtitle language.1. Select “Subtitle Language”.2. Select a language you want to readon the “Subtitle Language” screen.If you cannot find the language you want toread on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For the entry oflanguage code, see the following “ENTERAUDIO LANGUAGE CODE”.

To return to the “Setup Menu” screen, se-lect .

� DVD languageYou can change the language on theDVD video menu.1. Select “DVD Language”.2. Select the language you want toread on the “DVD Language” screen.If you cannot find the language you want toread on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For the entry oflanguage code, see the following “ENTERAUDIO LANGUAGE CODE”.

To return to the “Setup Menu” screen, se-lect .

Page 247: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

247

� Angle markThe multi−angle mark can be turned onor off on the screen while the discwhich is multi−angle compatible is be-ing played.1. Select “Angle Mark”.2. Select “On” or “Off”.� Parental lockThe level of viewer restrictions can bechanged.1. Select “Parental Lock”.2. Enter the 4−digit personal code onthe “Key code” screen.If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

To return to the “Setup Menu” screen, se-lect .

3. Select a parental level (1 — 8) on the“Select Restriction Level”. Select

to return to the “Setup Menu”screen.� Auto startDiscs that are inserted while the vehicle isin motion will automatically start playing.Certain discs may not play.

1. Select “Auto Start”.2. Select “On” or “Off”.� Sound dynamic range (if equipped)The difference between the lowest volumeand the highest volume can be adjusted.

1. Select “Sound Dynamic Range”.2. Select “MAX”, “STD” or “MIN”.

ENTER AUDIO LANGUAGE CODE

If you select “Other” on the “AudioLanguage” screen, “SubtitleLanguage” screen or “DVD Language”screen, you can select the languageyou want to hear or read by entering alanguage code.1. Enter the 4−digit language code.If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

2. Select “OK”.

Code Language

0514 English

1001 Japanese

0618 French

0405 German

0920 Italian

0519 Spanish

2608 Chinese

1412 Dutch

1620 Portuguese

1922 Swedish

1821 Russian

1115 Korean

0512 Greek

0101 Afar

0102 Abkhazian

Page 248: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

248

0106 Afrikaans

0113 Amharic

0118 Arabic

0119 Assamese

0125 Aymara

0126 Azerbaijani

0201 Bashkir

0205 Byelorussian

0207 Bulgarian

0208 Bihari

0209 Bislama

0214 Bengali

0215 Tibetan

0218 Breton

0301 Catalan

0315 Corsican

0319 Czech

0325 Welsh

0401 Danish

0426 Bhutani

0515 Esperanto

0520 Estonian

0521 Basque

0601 Persian

0609 Finnish

0610 Fiji

0615 Faroese

0625 Frisian

0701 Irish

0704 Scots−Gaelic

0712 Galician

0714 Guarani

0721 Gujarati

0801 Hausa

0809 Hindi

0818 Croatian

0821 Hungarian

0825 Armenian

0901 Interlingua

0905 Interlingue

0911 Inupiak

0914 Indonesian

0919 Icelandic

0923 Hebrew

1009 Yiddish

1023 Javanese

1101 Georgian

1111 Kazakh

1112 Greenlandic

1113 Cambodian

1114 Kannada

1119 Kashmiri

1121 Kurdish

1125 Kirghiz

1201 Latin

1214 Lingala

1215 Laothian

1220 Lithuanian

1222 Latvian

1307 Malagasy

1309 Maori

1311 Macedonian

1312 Malayalam

1314 Mongolian

Page 249: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

249

1315 Moldavian

1318 Marathi

1319 Malay

1320 Maltese

1325 Burmese

1401 Nauru

1405 Nepali

1415 Norwegian

1503 Occitan

1513 (Afan)Oromo

1518 Oriya

1601 Panjabi

1612 Polish

1619 Pashto, Pushto

1721 Quechua

1813 Rhaeto−Romance

1814 Kirundi

1815 Romanian

1823 Kinyarwanda

1901 Sanskrit

1904 Sindhi

1907 Sangho

1908 Serbo−Croatian

1909 Sinhalese

1911 Slovak

1912 Slovenian

1913 Samoan

1914 Shona

1915 Somali

1917 Albanian

1918 Serbian

1919 Siswati

1920 Sesotho

1921 Sundanese

1923 Swahili

2001 Tamil

2005 Telugu

2007 Tajik

2008 Thai

2009 Tigrinya

2011 Turkmen

2012 Tagalog

2014 Setswana

2015 Tonga

2018 Turkish

2019 Tsonga

2020 Tatar

2023 Twi

2111 Ukrainian

2118 Urdu

2126 Uzbek

2209 Vietnamese

2215 Volapük

2315 Wolof

2408 Xhosa

2515 Yoruba

2621 Zulu

Page 250: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

250

SETUP OPERATION FROM THE REARSEAT

This screen appears when a rear passen-ger selects the setup menu.

If you want to cancel the setup operationfrom the rear seat, select “Play”. Theplayer will resume normal play.

Under the same condition, the rear pas-senger can cancel the setup operationfrom the front seat.

To lock the operation of the player from therear seat, see “� Rear system lock” onpage 348.

(f) Operating a video CDPLAYING A VIDEO CD

Select “CD/DVD” tab to display thisscreen.When you select “Wide” on “Settings”screen, the screen mode can be changed.

If you select “Full Screen” when the ve-hicle is completely stopped and the park-ing brake is applied, the video screen re-turns.

Page 251: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

251

DISPLAYING VIDEO CD SETTINGS

If you select “Settings” on “Video CD”screen, “Settings” screen appears.

DESCRIPTION OF VIDEO CDSETTINGS� Controls on top page“Select Number”: The track or numbersearch screen appears. (See “SEARCH-ING BY TRACK” on page 253.)

“Prev. Page”: When you select this whilethe disc menu is displayed, the previouspage appears on the screen. If you selectthis while the player is playing video, theprevious track is searched and played.

“Next Page”: When you select this whilethe disc menu is displayed, the next pageappears on the display. If you select thiswhile the player is playing video, the nexttrack is searched and played.

“Main/Sub”: A multiplex transmissionchanging control. The mode changes fromMain/Sub to Main, to Sub and back toMain/Sub by selecting this control.

“Return”: Selecting this will display thepredetermined scene and start playingfrom there.

“Wide”: The screen mode screen ap-pears.

Page 252: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

252

DISPLAYING VIDEO CD CONTROLSIf you select the part where controls are notlocated while you are watching video onthe video CD, video CD controls will ap-pear.

If “ ” appears on the display when you se-lect a control, the operation is not per-mitted.

DESCRIPTION OF VIDEO CDCONTROLS

: Use this to pause the video screen.

: Select this to fast reverse during

playback.

: Select this to resume playing during

pause.

: Select this to fast forward during the

playback and start playing frame by frameduring pause.

Page 253: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

253

SEARCHING BY TRACK

Enter the track numbers and select“OK”. The player starts playing videofor that title number.You can select a track number by pushing“�” or “�” on the “SEEK·TRACK” but-ton.

If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

Select , and the previous screen re-turns.

(g) If the changer malfunctionsIf the changer or another unit equippedwith the changer malfunction, your audio/video system will display following mes-sages.

If “Check disc �” appears on thedisplay: It indicates that the disc dirty,damaged, or it was inserted upside down.Clean the disc or insert it correctly. If a discwhich is not playable is inserted, “Checkdisc �” will also appear on the screen. Forappropriate discs for this changer, see“Audio/video system operating hints” onpage 298.

If “Region code error” appears on thedisplay: It indicates that the DVD regioncode is not set properly.

If “DVD error” appears on the display:It indicates that the inside of the player unitmay be too hot due to the very high ambi-ent temperature. Remove the disc fromthe player and allow the player to cooldown.

If the malfunction is not rectified: Takeyour vehicle to your dealer.

If an MP3/WMA disc contains CD−DAfiles, only CD−DA files are played. If anMP3/WMA disc contains files other thanCD−DA, only MP3/WMA files are played.

Page 254: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

254

(h) DVD player and DVD video disc in-formationDVD VIDEO DISCSThis DVD player conforms to NTSC col-or TV formats. The DVD video disc con-forming to another formats such asPAL or SECAM cannot be used.Region codes: Some DVD video discshave a region code indicating a countrywhere you can use the DVD video disc onthis DVD player. If the DVD video disc isnot labeled as “ALL” or “1”, you cannot useit on this DVD player. If you attempt to playan inappropriate DVD video disc on thisplayer, “Region code error” appears on thescreen. Even if the DVD video disc doesnot have a region code, there is a case thatyou cannot use it.

Marks shown on DVD video discs:

Indicates NTSCformat of color TV.

Indicates the numberof audio tracks.

Indicates the numberof language subtitles.

Indicates the numberof angles.

Indicates the screen tobe selected.Wide screen: 16:9Standard: 4:3Indicates a region codeby which this video disccan be played.ALL: in all countriesNumber: region code

Page 255: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

255

DVD VIDEO DISC GLOSSARYDVD video discs: Digital Versatile Discthat holds video. DVD video discs haveadopted “MPEG2”, one of the world stan-dards of digital compression technologies.The picture data is compressed by 1/40 onaverage and stored. Variable rate en-coded technology in which the volume ofdata assigned to the picture is changed de-pending on the picture format has alsobeen adopted. Audio data is stored usingPCM and Dolby Digital, which enableshigher quality of sound. Furthermore, mul-ti−angle and multi−language features willalso help you enjoy the more advancedtechnology of DVD video.

Viewer restrictions: This feature limitswhat can be viewed in conformity with alevel of restrictions of the country. The lev-el of restrictions varies depending on theDVD video disc. Some DVD video discscannot be played at all, or violent scenesare skipped or replaced with other scenes.

Level 1: DVD video discs for children canbe played.

Level 2 − 7: DVD video discs for childrenand G−rated movie can be played.

Level 8: All types of the DVD video discscan be played.

Multi−angle feature: You can enjoy thesame scene at different angles.

Multi−language feature: You can select alanguage of the subtitle and audio.

Region codes: The region codes are pro-vided on DVD players and DVD discs. Ifthe DVD video disc does not have thesame region code as the DVD player, youcannot play the disc on the DVD player.For region codes, see page 254.

Audio: This DVD player can play linerPCM, Dolby Digital and MPEG audio for-mat DVD. Other decoded type cannot beplayed.

Title and chapter: Video and audio pro-grams stored in DVD video disc are divid-ed in parts by title and chapter.

Title: The largest unit of the video and au-dio programs stored on DVD video discs.Usually, one piece of movie, one album, orone audio program is assigned as a title.

Chapter: The unit smaller than that of title.A title comprises plural chapters.

Manufactured under license fromDolby Laboratories. “Dolby”, “Pro Log-ic”, and the double−D symbol are trade-marks of Dolby Laboratories.This product incorporates copyrightprotection technology that is protectedby method claims of certain U.S. pat-ents and other intellectual propertyrights owned by Macrovision Corpora-tion and other rights owners. Use ofthis copyright protection technologymust be authorized by MacrovisionCorporation, and is intended for homeand other limited viewing uses only un-less otherwise authorized by Macrovi-sion Corporation. Reverse engineeringor disassembly is prohibited.“DTS” and “DTS Digital Surround” areregistered trademarks of Digital The-ater Systems, Inc.

Page 256: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

256

The Bluetooth� audio system enablesusers to enjoy music played on a porta-ble player from the vehicle speaker viawireless communication.

This audio system supportsBluetooth�, a wireless data systemcapable of playing portable audiomusic without cables. If your portableplayer does not support Bluetooth�,the Bluetooth� audio system will notfunction.

INFORMATIONPortable players must correspond tothe following specifications in orderto be connected to the Bluetooth� au-dio system. However, please notethat some functions may be limiteddepending on the type of portableplayer.

� Bluetooth� SpecificationVer.1.1 or higher(Recommended: Ver.2.0+EDR orhigher)

� Profile

� A2DP (Advanced Audio Dis-tribution Profile) Ver.1.0

� AVRCP (Audio/Video RemoteControl Profile) Ver.1.0 or higher(Recommended: Ver.1.3 or higher)

Please go to “http://www.lexus.com/”to find approved Bluetooth� phonesfor this system.

— Bluetooth� audiooperation

Page 257: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

257

Bluetooth is a trademark owned byBluetooth SIG. Inc.

CAUTIONDo not operate the player’s controlsor connect to the Bluetooth� audiosystem while driving.

NOTICE

Do not leave your portable player inthe car. In particular, high tempera-tures inside the vehicle may damagethe portable player.

INFORMATION� In the following conditions, the

system may not function.� The portable player is turned off.� The portable player is not con-

nected.� The portable player has a low bat-

tery.� It may take time, the phone connec-

tion is carried out duringBluetooth� audio play.

1 Indicates the condition of theBluetooth� connection.

“Blue” indicates an excellent connectionto Bluetooth�.

“Yellow” indicates a bad connection toBluetooth�, resulting in possible deteriora-tion of audio quality.

: No connection to Bluetooth�.

2 Indicates the amount of batterycharge left.

Empty Full

Remaining charge is not displayed whilethe Bluetooth� is connecting.

The amount left does not always corre-spond with the one of your portable player.

This system doesn’t have a charging func-tion.

Page 258: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

258

An antenna for the Bluetooth�connection is built in to the instrumentpanel. The indication of the Bluetooth�connection may turn yellow and thesystem may not function when you usethe Bluetooth� portable player in thefollowing conditions.� Your portable player is obstructed by

certain objects (such as when it is be-hind the seat or in the glove box or con-sole box).

� Your portable player touches or is cov-ered with metal materials.

Leave the Bluetooth� portable player in aplace where the “Blue” indication is dis-played.

The portable player information is regis-tered when the Bluetooth� audio system isconnected. When you release possessionof your vehicle, remove your portable play-er. (See “(a) Removing a Bluetooth� au-dio” on page 411.)

FCC ID : AJDK021IC : 775E−K021

This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC Rules and RSS−Gen andRSS−210 of IC Rules. Operation is sub-ject to the following two conditions : (1)This device may not cause harmful inter-ference, and (2) this device must acceptany interference received, including in-terference that may cause undesiredoperation.

CAUTION

FCC WARNING: Changes or modifi-cations not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compliancecould void the user’s authority to op-erate the equipment.

CAUTION: Radio Frequency Radi-ation ExposureThis equipment complies with FCCradiation exposure limits set forth foruncontrolled equipment and meetsthe FCC radio frequency (RF) Expo-sure Guidelines in Supplement C toOET65. This equipment has very lowlevels of RF energy that it deemed tocomply without maximum permis-sive exposure evaluation (MPE). Butit is desirable that it should beinstalled and operated with at least 20cm and more between the radiatorand person’s body (excluding ex-tremities: hands, wrists, feet andankles).Co−location: This transmitter mustnot be co−located or operated in con-junction with any other antenna ortransmitter.

Page 259: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

259

(a) Connecting Bluetooth� audio play-erTo use the Bluetooth� audio system,you need to register your portableplayer with the system. Once you haveregistered it, you can enjoy your musicon the vehicle’s audio system. (See“—Setting Bluetooth� audio” on page410.)For the operation procedure for theportable player, see the instructionmanual that comes with it.� When the connection method is

“From Vehicle”.� When the auto connection is on

When the portable player isstandby for the connection, itwill be automatically connectedwhenever the “POWER” <“EN-GINE START STOP”> switch isin either ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode.

� When the auto connection is offManually connect the portableplayer in accordance with thefollowing procedure.

Select “Connect”.

When the connection is completed, thisscreen is displayed. Now you can use theportable player.

This screen will appear when the connec-tion has failed.

Page 260: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

260

� When the connection method is“From Portable Player”

Operate the portable player and con-nect it to the Bluetooth� audio system.For the operation procedure for theportable player, see the instructionmanual that comes with it.

Select “Connect”.

Connect the portable audio player to theBluetooth� audio system.

This screen will appear when the connec-tion has been successfully established.

� Reconnecting the portable playerIf the portable player is disconnected witha poor reception from the Bluetooth� net-work when the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is in ACCESSO-RY or ON <IGNITION ON> mode, the sys-tem automatically reconnects the portableplayer.

If the Bluetooth� is disconnected on pur-pose such as you turned your portableplayer off, this does not happen.

Reconnect it by the following method.

� Select the portable player again.� Enter the portable player.

Page 261: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

261

(b) Playing a Bluetooth� audio� Playing and pausing a Bluetooth�

audio

Select “BT” tab if the Bluetooth� audioplayer is already connected.

Select and the music will start playing.

Select and the music will pause.

Select and the music will start playingagain.

Depending on the portable player that isconnected to the system, the music may

start playing when selecting while it ispaused. On the other hand, the music may

pause when selecting while it is play-ing.

Some titles may not be displayed depend-ing on the type of portable player.

Page 262: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

262

� Selecting a desired track

“SEEK·TRACK” button: Use for directaccess to a desired track.

Push either side of the “SEEK·TRACK”button and repeat it until the desired tracknumber appears on the screen. As you re-lease the button, the portable player willstart playing the selected track from thebeginning.

Fast forward:Push and hold the “�” button of“SEEK·TRACK” to fast forward the play-er. When you release the button, the porta-ble player will resume playing from thatposition.

Reverse:Push and hold the “�” button of“SEEK·TRACK” to reverse the player.When you release the button, the playerwill resume playing.

INFORMATIONDepending on the portable player thatis connected to the system, certainfunctions may not be available.

� Selecting a desired album

“Album ”: Select this button to go tothe next album.“Album ”: Select this button to go tothe previous album.

INFORMATIONDepending on the portable player thatis connected to the system, certainfunctions may not be available.

Page 263: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

263

� Other function

“RPT”: Use this control to automatic re-play the track you are currently listening to.

Repeating a track—While the track is playing, select “RPT”briefly.“RPT” appears on the screen. When thetrack is finished, the player will automati-cally play it again. To cancel the repeat, se-lect “RPT” once again.

“RAND”: Use this for automatic and ran-dom selection of tracks on the album thatyou are currently listening to.

Playing the tracks in the album in ran-dom order—While the track is playing, select“RAND” briefly.“RAND” appears on the screen. The sys-tem selects a track in the album you arecurrently listening to. To cancel this func-tion, select “RAND” once again.

INFORMATIONDepending on the portable player thatis connected to the system, certainfunctions may not be available.

Page 264: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

264

Connecting a USB memory or iPod en-ables you to enjoy music from the ve-hicle speakers.

CAUTIONDo not operate the player’s controlsor connect the USB memory or iPodwhile driving.

NOTICE

� Do not leave your portable player inthe car. In particular, high tempera-tures inside the vehicle may dam-age the portable player.

� Do not push down on or apply un-necessary pressure to the portableplayer while it is connected as thismay damage the portable player orits terminal.

� Do not insert foreign objects intothe port as this may damage theportable player or its terminal.

(a) Connecting a USB memory or iPod

1. Slide the armrest while pulling upthe lever, and lift the armrest.2. Remove the upper trays (ifequipped).

3. Remove the lower tray.

—USB memory/iPodoperation

Page 265: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

265

4. Open the cover and connect a USBmemory or iPod using an iPod cable.Turn on the power of the USB memory oriPod if it is not turned on.

� Routing portable audio devicecables

When the cover is slide open, portable au-dio device cables can be pulled throughthe opening.

Page 266: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

266

(b) Playing a USB memory or iPod� Playing and pausing a file or track

� USB memory

� iPod

Select “USB” tab to display this screenif the USB memory or iPod is alreadyconnected.

Select and the music will start playing.

Select and the music will pause.

Select and the music will start playingagain.

INFORMATION� When an iPod is connected and the

audio source is changed to iPodmode, the iPod will resume playfrom the same point in which it waslast used.

� When the USB memory is con-nected and the audio source ischanged to USB memory mode,the USB memory will start playingthe first file in the first folder. If thesame device is removed and rein-serted (and the contents have notbeen changed), the USB memorywill resume play from the samepoint in which it was last used.

� Depending on the iPod or USBmemory that is connected to thesystem, certain functions may notbe available.

Page 267: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

267

� Selecting a play mode (iPod only)

1. Select “Menu”.

2. Select the desired play mode.

� Selecting a desired folder (USBmemory only)

“Folder”: Select this button to go to thenext folder.

“Folder”: Select this button to go to theprevious folder.

“Select” for Folder: The desired foldercan be selected in a list. This function isavailable only when the vehicle is not mov-ing.

Select “Select”. The folder list is dis-played.

Select the desired folder number. The sys-tem will start playing the first file of the se-lected folder.

: By selecting this button, the list

moves up by 5 folder groups. If this buttonis selected when the top page of the list isdisplayed, the last page is displayed.

Page 268: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

268

: By selecting this button, the list

moves down by 5 folder groups. If this but-ton is selected when the last page of the listis displayed, the top page is displayed.

� Selecting a desired file or track

“SEEK·TRACK” button: Use for directaccess to a desired file or track.

Push either side of the “SEEK·TRACK”button and repeat it until the desired file ortrack appears on the screen. As yourelease the button, the USB memory oriPod will start playing the selected file ortrack from the beginning.

Fast forward:Push and hold the “�” button of“SEEK·TRACK” to fast forward the play-er. When you release the button, the play-er will resume playing from that position.

Reverse:Push and hold the “�” button of“SEEK·TRACK” to reverse the player.When you release the button, the playerwill resume playing.

Page 269: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

269

“TUNE·FILE” knob: Use for direct accessto a desired file or track in the player.

Turn the “TUNE·FILE” knob to step up ordown all the files or tracks in the player youare currently listening to.

� USB memory

� iPod

“Select” for File or Track: The desiredfile or track can be selected in a list. Thisfunction is available only when the vehicleis not moving.

Select “Select”. The file or track list is dis-played.

Page 270: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

270

Select the desired file or track number.The system will start playing the selectedfile or track from the beginning.

: By selecting this button, the list

moves up by 5 file or track groups. If thisbutton is selected when the top page of thelist is displayed, the last page is displayed.

: By selecting this button, the list

moves down by 5 file or track groups. Ifthis button is selected when the last pageof the list is displayed, the top page is dis-played.

� Searching for a desired file (USBmemory only)

Select “SCAN” on the screen or pushthe “SCAN” button briefly while themusic is playing.“SCAN” appears on the screen. The play-er will play the next file for 10 seconds,then scan again. To select a file, select“SCAN” on the screen or push the“SCAN” button a second time. If the play-er reaches the end of the memory, it willcontinue scanning at file1.

After all the files are scanned in one pass,normal play resumes.

Page 271: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

271

� Searching for a desired folder (USBmemory only)

Select “SCAN” on the screen or pushthe “SCAN” button for longer than asecond while the music is playing.“FLD.SCAN” appears on the screen. Theprogram at the beginning of each folder willbe played for 10 seconds. To continue lis-tening to the program of your choice, se-lect “SCAN” on the screen or push the“SCAN” button a second time.

After all the folders are scanned in onepass, normal play resumes.

� Other function

� USB memory

� iPod

“RPT”: Use this control to automatic re-play the file or track you are currently lis-tening to.

Repeating a file or track—While the file or track is playing, select“RPT” briefly.“RPT” appears on the screen. When thefile or track is finished, the player will auto-matically play it again. To cancel the re-peat, select “RPT” once again.

Page 272: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

272

Repeating a folder (USB memory only)—While the folder is playing, select“RPT” for longer than a second.“FLD.RPT” appears on the screen. Whenthe folder is finished, the system will auto-matically go back to the beginning of thefolder and play the folder again. To cancelit, select “RPT” once again.

“RAND”: Use this for automatic and ran-dom selection of files or tracks on the fold-er that you are currently listening to.

Playing the file or track in random or-der—While the file or track is playing, select“RAND” briefly.“RAND” appears on the screen. The sys-tem selects a file or track you are currentlylistening to. To cancel this function, select“RAND” once again.

Playing the files in all files in random or-der —Select “RAND” for longer than a secondwhile the music is playing. “FLD.RAND”appears on the screen. The system se-lects a file in all files. To cancel it, select“RAND” once again.

When a file is skipped or the system is in-operative, select “RAND” to reset.

Some functions of the audio system can beadjusted using the switches on the steer-ing wheel.

Details of the specific switches, controls,and features are described below.1 Volume control switch2 “MODE” switch3 “��” switch

1 Volume control switchPush “+” side to increase the volume. Thevolume continues to increase while theswitch is being pressed.

Push “–” side to decrease the volume.The volume continues to decrease whilethe switch is being pressed.

Audio/video remote controls(steering switches)

Page 273: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

273

2 “MODE” switchPush “MODE” switch to select an audiomode. Each push changes the mode se-quentially if the desired mode is ready touse.

To turn the audio/video system on, pushthe “MODE” switch.

To turn the audio/video system off, pushand hold the “MODE” switch until you heara beep.3 “��” switch

RadioThis switch has the following features—

To select a preset station:Quickly push and release the “�” or “�”side of the switch. Do this again to selectthe next preset station.

To seek a station:Push and hold the “�” or “�” side of theswitch until you hear a beep. Do this againto find the next station. If you push theswitch on either side during the seekmode, seeking will be cancelled.

To step up or down the frequency, pushand hold the switch even after you hear abeep. When you release from the switch,the radio will begin seeking up or down fora station. Do this again to find the next sta-tion.

XM� Satellite Radio—

To select a preset channel, push the “�”or “�” side of the switch. Repeat until adesired channel is found.

CD changer or DVD changerUse this switch to skip up or down to a dif-ferent track, file or chapter in either direc-tion.

To select a desired track, file or chapter:Quickly push and release the “�” or “�”side of the switch until the track, file orchapter you want to play is set. If you wantto return to the beginning of the currenttrack, file or chapter, push the “�” side ofthe switch once, quickly.

To select a desired disc:Push and hold the “�” or “�” switch untilyou hear a beep to change to the next orthe previous disc. Repeat this operationuntil you reach the disc you want to listento.

Bluetooth� audio playerUse this switch to skip up or down to a dif-ferent track or album in either direction.

To select a desired track:Quickly push and release the “�” or “�”side of the switch until the track you wantto listen to is set. If you want to return to thebeginning of the current track, push the“�” side of the switch once quickly.

To select a desired album:Push and hold “�” or “�” switch until youhear a beep to change to the next or theprevious album. Repeat this operation un-til you reach the album you want to listento.

USB memory/iPodUse this switch to skip up or down to a dif-ferent file or track in either direction.

To select a desired file or track:Push the “�” or “�” side of the switch un-til the file or track you want to listen to is set.If you want to return to the beginning of thecurrent file or track, push the “�” side ofthe switch once quickly.

To select a desired folder (USB memoryonly):

Push and hold “�” or “�” switch until youhear a beep to change to the next or theprevious folder. Repeat this operation untilyou reach the folder you want to listen to.

Page 274: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

274

The rear seat entertainment system is designed for the rear passengers to enjoy audioand DVD video.

1 Front audio system2 Displays3 Rear seat entertainment system con-

troller

4 Power outlet5 A/V input port6 Headphone volume control dials and

headphone jacks

Rear seat entertainment system features —

Page 275: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

275

The rear seat entertainment system canbe used when the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is in ACCESSORYor ON <IGNITION ON> mode.

� Displays

A display is installed in the back of eachfront seat. When audio−video equipmentis connected to the A/V input port, rearpassengers can enjoy different audiosources on each display. See “—Using thevideo mode” on page 295.

� Rear seat entertainment systemcontroller

Use the controller to operate both the leftand right side displays. Some controllerbuttons are shared between the left andright side displays. When operating thosebuttons, first select the desired display us-ing the select display switch.

To operate, aim the controller at the de-sired display.

1 Controller buttons for the left side dis-play

2 Controller buttons for the right sidedisplay

3 Turns display off4 Selects the display to be operated

(for some controller buttons only)

Page 276: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

276

� Before using the controller (for newvehicle owners)

An insulating sheet is set to prevent thebatteries from being discharged. Removethe insulating sheet before using the re-mote control.

� Replacing the controller batteriesNecessary item for replacing “2 AA bat-teries”.

1. Remove the cover.

2. Remove the depleted batteries andinstall the new ones.

Page 277: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

277

If the batteries are discharged, the fol-lowing symptoms may occur.� The rear seat entertainment system

controller will not function properly.

� The operational range is reduced.

When using 2 AA batteries� Batteries can be purchased at your

Lexus dealer, electric appliance shop,or camera stores.

� Replace only with the same or equiva-lent type recommended by a Lexusdealer.

� Dispose of used batteries according tothe local laws.

� Headphone jacks

1 To use the headphones, connectthem to the jack.

2 To adjust the volume1. Push the knob.2. Turn the knob clockwise to increasethe volume. Turn the knob counter-clockwise to decrease the volume.3. Push the knob again.� HeadphonesWith some headphones generally avail-able in the market, it may be difficult tocatch signals properly. Lexus recom-mends the use of Lexus genuine wirelessheadphones.

Please contact your Lexus dealer for fur-ther details.

� VolumeAdjust the volume when you connect theheadphones to the jack. Loud sounds mayhave a significant impact on the humanbody.

Page 278: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

278

� Caution screen

This screen appears for a few secondswhen the “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode.

� Changing the source

1 Turning on the audio source selectionscreen

2 Inputting the selected icon3 Selecting an icon

Push “SOURCE” to display the audiosource selection screen.

Select an audio source.

Page 279: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

279

� Changing the speaker output

To play the rear audio over the speakers inthe vehicle, turn “Speaker Output” on.

CAUTION

� While drivingDo not use headphones. Doing so may cause an accident,resulting in death or serious injury.

� To prevent accidents and electricshockDo not disassemble or modify theremote control.

� When the remote control is notusedStow the remote control. Injuriesmay result in the event of an acci-dent or sudden braking.

� Conversational speech on someDVDs is recorded at a low volumeto emphasize the impact of soundeffects. If you adjust the volumeassuming that the conversationsrepresent the maximum volumelevel that the DVD will play, youmay be startled by louder sound ef-fects or when you change to a dif-ferent audio source. The loudersounds may have a significant im-pact on the human body or pose adriving hazard. Keep this in mindwhen you adjust the volume.

� Removed battery and other parts:� Keep away from children.� These parts are small and if swal-

lowed by a child they can causechoking.

Page 280: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

280

NOTICE

� Cleaning the display

Wipe the display with a dry softcloth.

If the screen is wiped with a roughcloth, the surface of the screenmay be scratched.

� To prevent damage to the remotecontrol

Keep the remote control away fromdirect sunlight, temperature heatand high humidity.

Do not drop or knock the remotecontrol against hard objects.

Do not sit on or place heavy ob-jects on the remote control.

� For normal operation after replac-ing the battery, observe the follow-ing precautions to prevent acci-dents:� Always work with dry hands.

Moisture may cause the batteryto rust.

� Do not touch or move any othercomponents inside the remotecontrol.

� Do not bend either of the batteryterminals.

Select radio mode on the source screen todisplay the control screen.

1 Selecting a preset station2 Tuning the station� Selecting a preset stationPush “ ” or “ ” of “DISC·CH” until thedesired station band appears on thescreen.

� Tuning the stationPush “ ” or “ ” of “TUNE” until the de-sired station appears on the screen.

Push “ ” or “ ” of “TUNE” and the sta-tions will be searched automatically oneafter another.

— Using the radio

Page 281: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

281

1 Turning on DVD player mode2 Selecting a disc� Selecting a disc

Push “ ” or “ ” of “DISC·CH” until thedesired disc number appears on thescreen.

� Audio CD, CD text 281. . . . . . . . . . . .

� MP3/WMA disc 282. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� DVD video/audio 282. . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Video CD 292. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Selecting a track

Push “ ” or “ ” of “TUNE” until the de-sired track number appears on the screen.

� Fast forwarding or reversing a trackPush and hold “ ” or “ ” of “TUNE”.

— Using the DVD player— Playing an audio CD/CDtext

Page 282: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

282

� Selecting a file

1 Selecting a file2 Selecting a folder

Push “ ” or “ ” of “TUNE” until the de-sired file number appears on the screen.

� Selecting a folderPush “ ” or “ ” of “FOLDER” until thedesired folder number appears on thescreen.

� Fast forwarding or reversing a filePush “ ” or “ ” of “TUNE”.

� Controller

— Playing WMA/MP3 discs — Playing DVD video/audio

Page 283: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

283

1 Turning on the DVD mode2 Inputting the selected icon3 Selecting an icon4 Turning on the menu disc5 Playing/pausing a disc6 Fast forwarding a disc7 Turning on the control icon screen8 Reversing a disc9 Turning on the title selection screen

10 Push to select a chapter/track

Push and hold to fast forwarding orreversing a chapter/track

� DVD video and DVD audioPush “OPTION” if no icons are shownwhile watching a DVD video or DVD audio,and following screens appear.

� DVD video

� DVD audio

“Settings”: Selecting this will display set-ting screen.

“Hide Buttons”: Selecting this will turn offthe icons from the screen.

If “ ” appears on the screen when you se-lect a control, the operation relevant to thecontrol is not permitted.

Page 284: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

284

DESCRIPTION OF DVD VIDEO CON-TROLS“Menu” and “Top Menu”: If you selectany of the above controls, the menuscreen for DVD video appears. (For theoperation, see the manual that comes withthe DVD video disc provided separately.)

: Selecting this will fast reverse dur-

ing playback.

: Selecting this will stop the video

screen.

: Selecting this will pause/resumethe video screen.

: Selecting this will fast forward dur-

ing playback and forward frame by frameduring pause.

DESCRIPTION OF DVD AUDIO CON-TROLS“Top Menu”: If you select this button, themenu screen for DVD audio appears. (Forthe operation, see the manual that comeswith the DVD audio disc provided sepa-rately.)

“Audio”: The audio changing screen ap-pears. (See page 289.)

: Selecting this will fast reverse dur-

ing playback.

: Selecting this will stop the disc.

: Selecting this will pause/resumethe disc.

: Selecting this will fast forward dur-

ing playback and forward frame by frameduring pause.

Page 285: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

285

DVD SETTINGSWhen “Settings” is selected on the con-trol icon screens, the following screens willappear according to audio mode.

� DVD video

� DVD audio

DESCRIPTION OF DVD VIDEO SET-TINGS“Setup”: The initial set up screen ap-pears. (See page 290.)

“Search”: The title search screen ap-pears. (See page 286.)

“Return”: Selecting this will display thepredetermined scene and start playingfrom there.

“Audio”: The audio changing screen ap-pears. (See page 289.)

“Subtitle”: The subtitle changing screenappears. (See page 288.)

“Angle”: The angle selection screen ap-pears. (See page 290.)

Page 286: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

286

DESCRIPTION OF DVD AUDIO SET-TINGS“Setup”: The initial set up screen ap-pears. (See page 290.)

“Select Number”: The track or numbersearch screen appears. (See page 288.)

“Search”: The group search screen ap-pears.

“Return”: Selecting this will display thepredetermined scene and start playingfrom there.

“Prev. Page”: Select this button to re-verse the pages.

“Next Page”: Select this button to forwardthe pages.

“Subtitle”: The subtitle changing screenappears. (See page 288.)

“Angle”: The angle selection screen ap-pears. (See page 290.)

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

SEARCHING BY TITLE

DVD video only—

Select “Search” on the settings screen.Enter the title number and select “OK”.The player starts playing video for thattitle number.When you push “ ” or “ ” of “TUNE”,you can select a chapter.

If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

Page 287: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

287

SEARCHING BY GROUP

DVD audio only —

Select “Search” on the settings screen.Enter the group number and select“OK”. The player starts playing thedisc for that group number.When you push “ ” or “ ” of “TUNE”,you can select a track.

If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

SELECTING THE BONUS GROUP

DVD audio only —

Select “Search” on the settings screen.Enter the bonus group number on thesearching group screen and select“OK”.The “Enter Key Code” screen will appear.To enter the number of the group you wantto play, select the group number.

If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

Select “OK” on the screen.The player starts playing the disc from theselected bonus group number.

Page 288: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

288

SELECTING THE MENU NUMBERDVD audio only —

Select “Select Number” on the settingsscreen.Enter the menu number and select“OK”.If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

CHANGING THE SUBTITLELANGUAGE

Select “Subtitle” on the settingsscreen.Each time you select “Subtitle”, the lan-guage is selected from the ones storedin the discs and changed.When you select “Hide”, the subtitle canbe hidden.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

Page 289: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

289

CHANGING THE AUDIO LANGUAGE

DVD video only —

Select “Audio” on the settings screen.Each time you select “Audio”, the lan-guage is selected from the ones storedin the discs and changed.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

CHANGING THE AUDIO FORMATDVD audio only —

Select “Audio” on the control iconscreen.Each time you select “Audio”, anotheraudio format stored on the disc is se-lected.

When you select , the previousscreen returns.

Page 290: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

290

CHANGING THE ANGLESelect “Angle” on the settings screen.The angle can be selected for discs thatare multi−angle compatible when theangle mark appears on the screen.Each time you select “Angle”, the angleis selected from the ones stored in thediscs and changed.

When you select , and the previousscreen returns.

SETUP MENU

Select “Setup” on the settings screen.There are initial setting buttons on the“Setup Menu” screen.After you change the initial setting, select“OK”. The initial setting screen will beturned off and return to the picturepreviously.

When “Default” is selected, all menus areinitialized.

The initial setting can be changed.

Page 291: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

291

� Audio languageYou can change the audio language.1. Select “Audio Language”.2. Select the language you want tohear on the “Audio Language” screen.If you cannot find the language you want tohear on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For the entry oflanguage code, see the following “ENTERAUDIO LANGUAGE CODE”.

To return to the “Setup Menu” screen, se-lect .

� Subtitle languageYou can change the subtitle language.1. Select “Subtitle Language”.2. Select a language you want to readon the “Subtitle Language” screen.If you cannot find the language you want toread on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For the entry oflanguage code, see the following “ENTERAUDIO LANGUAGE CODE”.

To return to the “Setup Menu” screen, se-lect .

� DVD languageYou can change the language on theDVD video menu.1. Select “DVD Language”.2. Select the language you want toread on the “DVD Language” screen.If you cannot find the language you want toread on this screen, select “Other” andenter a language code. For the entry oflanguage code, see the following “ENTERAUDIO LANGUAGE CODE”.

To return to the “Setup Menu” screen, se-lect .

� Angle markThe multi−angle mark can be turned onor off on the screen while the discwhich is multi−angle compatible is be-ing played.1. Select “Angle Mark”.2. Select “ON” or “OFF”.� Parental lockThe level of viewer restrictions can bechanged.1. Select “Parental Lock”.2. Enter the 4−digit personal code onthe “Key code” screen.If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

To return to the “Setup Menu” screen, se-lect .

3. Select a parental level (1 — 8) on the“Select Restriction Level”. Select

to return to the “Setup Menu”screen.� Sound dynamic range (if equipped)The difference between the lowest volumeand the highest volume can be adjusted.

1. Select “Sound Dynamic Range”.2. Select “MAX”, “STD” or “MIN”.

Page 292: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

292

ENTER AUDIO LANGUAGE CODE

If you select “Other” on the “AudioLanguage” screen, “SubtitleLanguage” screen or “DVD Language”screen, you can select the languageyou want to hear or read by entering alanguage code. (See page 247.)1. Enter the 4−digit language code.If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

2. Select “OK”.

� Video CDPush “OPTION” if no icons are shownwhile watching a video CD, and followingscreen appears.

“Settings”: Selecting this will display set-ting screen.

“Hide Buttons”: Selecting this will turn offthe icons from the screen.

If “ ” appears on the display when you se-lect a control, the operation is not per-mitted.

Page 293: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

293

DESCRIPTION OF VIDEO CDCONTROLS

: Select this to fast reverse during

playback.

: Selecting this will stop the video

screen.

: Use this to pause/resume the vid-eo screen.

: Select this to fast forward during the

playback and start playing frame by frameduring pause.

VIDEO CD SETTINGSWhen “Settings” is selected on the con-trol icon screen, the following screen willappear.

Page 294: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

294

DESCRIPTION OF VIDEO CDSETTINGS“Select Number”: The track or numbersearch screen appears. (See “SEARCH-ING BY TRACK” on page 294.)

“Return”: Selecting this will display thepredetermined scene and start playingfrom there.

“Prev. Page”: When you select this whilethe disc menu is displayed, the previouspage appears on the screen. If you selectthis while the player is playing video, theprevious track is searched and played.

“Next Page”: When you select this whilethe disc menu is displayed, the next pageappears on the display. If you select thiswhile the player is playing video, the nexttrack is searched and played.

“MAIN/SUB”: A multiplex transmissionchanging control. The mode changes fromMain/Sub to Main, to Sub and back toMain/Sub by selecting this control.

SEARCHING BY TRACKSelect “Select Number” on the settingsscreen.Enter the track numbers and select“OK”. The player starts playing videofor that title number.You can select a track number by pushing“ ” or “ ” of “TUNE”.

If you enter the wrong numbers, select

to delete the numbers.

Select , and the previous screen re-turns.

Page 295: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

295

Push “VIDEO” to select the video mode.

Before switching to the video mode, con-nect the audio−video equipment to the A/Vinput port.

When “Speaker Output” is off, any au-dio−video source can be selected for theother rear display. See “� Changing thespeaker output” on page 279.

� Using the A/V input port

Open the cover.The A/V input port is composed of 3 inputports.

Yellow: Video input port

White: Left channel audio input port

Red: Right channel audio input port

The rear seat entertainment system playsvideos and sound when audio−videoequipment is connected to the A/V inputport. For details, refer to the manufactur-er’s instructions.

The power outlet is used to connect the au-dio−video equipment. See the vehicleowner’s manual.

NOTICE

When the A/V input port is not in use,keep the A/V input port cover closed.Inserting anything other than an ap-propriate plug may cause electricalfailure or a short circuit.

— Using the video mode

Page 296: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

296

� Changing to PAL format

Push “DISPLAY”.

If the video does not appear, turn “PALVIDEO” on.

“PAL VIDEO” will be displayed when PALformat equipment is connected to the A/Vinput port.

� Setting the display mode

Pushing “SIZE” changes the displaymodes sequentially as follows:

Normal → Wide 1 → Wide 2

— Changing other settings

Page 297: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

297

� Adjusting the screen

Push “DISPLAY”.

Select the desired button to adjust col-or, tone, contrast and brightness. Afteradjusting the screen, select “OK”.

“Color” “R”:Strengthens the red color of the screen.

“Color” “G”:Strengthens the green color of the screen.

“Tone” “+”: Strengthens the tone of thescreen.

“Tone” “−”: Weakens the tone of thescreen.

“Contrast” “+”:Strengthens the contrast of the screen.

“Contrast” “−”:Weakens the contrast of the screen.

“Brightness” “+”:Brightens the screen.

“Brightness” “−”:Darkens the screen.

The screen goes off when “Screen Off” isselected. To turn the display screen backon, push “DVD”, “VIDEO”, “OFF” or“DISPLAY” for the display. The selectedscreen appears.

Page 298: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

298

NOTICE

To ensure correct audio/video sys-tem operations:

� Be careful not to spill beveragesover the audio/video system.

� Do not put anything other than anappropriate discs into the CDchanger or DVD changer.

� The use of a cellular phone insideor near the vehicle may cause anoise from the speakers of the au-dio/video system which you are lis-tening to. However, this does notindicate a malfunction.

� Radio receptionUsually, a problem with radio receptiondoes not mean there is a problem with yourradio — it is just the normal result of condi-tions outside the vehicle.

For example, nearby buildings and terraincan interfere with FM reception. Powerlines or telephone wires can interfere withAM signals. And of course, radio signalshave a limited range. The farther you arefrom a station, the weaker its signal will be.In addition, reception conditions changeconstantly as your vehicle moves.

Here are some common reception prob-lems that probably do not indicate a prob-lem with your radio:

FMFading and drifting stations — Generally,the effective range of FM is about 25 miles(40 km). Once outside this range, you maynotice fading and drifting, which increasewith the distance from the radio transmit-ter. They are often accompanied by distor-tion.

Multi−path — FM signals are reflective,making it possible for two signals to reachyour antenna at the same time. If this hap-pens, the signals will cancel each otherout, causing a momentary flutter or loss ofreception.

Static and fluttering — These occur whensignals are blocked by buildings, trees, orother large objects. Increasing the basslevel may reduce static and fluttering.

Station swapping — If the FM signal youare listening to is interrupted or weakened,and there is another strong station nearbyon the FM band, your radio may tune in thesecond station until the original signal canbe picked up again.

AMFading — AM broadcasts are reflected bythe upper atmosphere — especially atnight. These reflected signals can inter-fere with those received directly from theradio station, causing the radio station tosound alternately strong and weak.

Station interference — When a reflectedsignal and a signal received directly froma radio station are very nearly the samefrequency, they can interfere with eachother, making it difficult to hear the broad-cast.

Static — AM is easily affected by externalsources of electrical noise, such as hightension power lines, lightening, or electri-cal motors. This results in static.

Audio/video systemoperating hints

Page 299: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

299

XM�

Cargo loaded on the roof luggage carrier,especially metal objects, may adverselyaffect the reception of XM� Satellite Radio.

Alternation or modifications carried outwithout appropriate authorization may in-validate the user’s right to operate theequipment.

iPodAbout iPod —� Apple is not responsible for the opera-

tion of this device or its compliance withsafety and regulatory standards.

� iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., regis-tered in the U.S. and other countries.

Compatible models —

Model Generation Software version

iPod 5th generation

Ver. 1.2.0 orhigher

iPodnano

1st generation

Ver. 1.3.0 orhigher

2nd generation

Ver. 1.1.2 orhigher

3rd generation

Ver. 1.0.0 orhigher

iPodtouch

1st generation

Ver. 1.1.0 orhigher

iPodclassic

1st generation

Ver. 1.0.0 orhigher

Depending on differences between mod-els or software versions etc., some modelslisted above might be incompatible withthis system. iPod 4th generation and earlier models arenot compatible with this system. iPhone, iPod mini, iPod shuffle and iPodphoto are not compatible with this system.

USB memoryUSB memory that can be used for MP3and WMA playback.

� USB communication formats: USB 2.0FS (12 MBPS)

� File formats: FAT 16/32 (Windows�)

� Correspondence class: Mass storageclass

Page 300: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

300

CARING FOR YOUR CD CHANGER,DVD CHANGER AND DISCS� Your CD changer and DVD changer is

intended for use with 4.7 in. (12 cm)discs only.

� Extremely high temperatures can keepyour CD changer and DVD changerfrom working. On hot days, use the airconditioning to cool the vehicle interiorbefore you use the changer and player.

� Bumpy roads or other vibrations maymake your CD changer and DVD chan-ger skip.

� If moisture gets into your CD changerand DVD changer, you may not playeven though they appear to be workin-g. Remove the discs from the changerand wait until it dries.

CAUTIONCD changer and DVD changer use aninvisible laser beam which couldcause hazardous radiation exposureif directed outside the unit. Be sure tooperate the changers correctly.

CD changer

XS18016

� Use only discs marked as shown abo-ve. The following products may not beplayable on your changer.

SACDCopy−protected CDCD−ROM

Page 301: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

301

DVD changer

Audio CDs

DVD videodiscs

Video CDs

DVD audiodiscs

� Use only discs marked as shown abo-ve. The following products may not beplayable on your changer.

SACDCopy−protected CDCD−ROMDVD+RDVD+RWDVD−ROMDVD−RAM

� Special shaped discs

� Transparent/translucent discs

� Low quality discs

Page 302: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

302

� Labeled discs

NOTICE

� Do not use special shaped, trans-parent/translucent, low quality orlabeled discs such as those shownin the illustrations. The use of suchdiscs may damage the player orchanger, or it may be impossible toeject the disc.

� This system is not designed for useof Dual Disc. Do not use Dual Discbecause it may cause damage tothe changer.

� Do not use a disc with protectionring. The use of such disc maydamage the changer, or it may beimpossible to eject the disc.

� Correct � Wrong

� Handle discs carefully, especiallywhen you are inserting them. Holdthem on the edge and do not bend the-m. Avoid getting fingerprints on them,particularly on the shiny side.

� Dirt, scratches, warping, pin holes, orother disc damage could cause theplayer to skip or to repeat a section ofa track. (To see a pin hole, hold the discup to the light.)

� Remove discs from the players whenyou are not using them. Store them intheir plastic cases away from moisture,heat, and direct sunlight.

Page 303: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

303

To clean a disc: Wipe it with a soft, lint−free cloth that has been dampened withwater. Wipe in a straight line from the cen-ter to the edge of the disc (not in circles).Dry it with another soft, lint−free cloth. Donot use a conventional record cleaner oranti−static device.

MP3/WMA FILES� MP3 (MPEG Audio Layer 3) and WMA

(Windows Media Audio) are audiocompression standards.

� The MP3/WMA player can play MP3and WMA files on CD−ROM, CD−Rand CD−RW discs.

The unit can play disc recordings com-patible with ISO 9660 level 1 and level2 and with the Romeo and Joliet filesystem.

� When naming an MP3 or WMA file, addthe appropriate file extension (.mp3 or.wma).

� The MP3/WMA player plays back fileswith .mp3 or .wma file extensions asMP3 or WMA files. To prevent noiseand playback errors, use the appropri-ate file extensions.

� The MP3/WMA player can play onlythe first session using multi−sessioncompatible CDs.

� MP3 player—MP3 files are compatiblewith the ID3 Tag Ver. 1.0, Ver. 1.1, Ver.2.2, and Ver. 2.3 formats. The unit can-not display disc title, track title and art-ist name in other formats.

� USB memory—MP3 files are compat-ible with the ID3 Tag Ver. 1.0, Ver. 1.1,Ver. 2.2, Ver. 2.3 and Ver. 2.4 formats.The unit cannot display track title andartist name in other formats.

� WMA files can contain a WMA tag thatis used in the same way as an ID3 tag.WMA tags carry information such astrack title, artist name.

� The emphasis function is availableonly when playing MP3/WMA files re-corded at 32, 44.1 and 48 kHz.

Page 304: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

304

Sampling frequencyMP3 files for MP3 player:MPEG 1 LAYER 3—32, 44.1, 48 kHzMPEG 2 LSF LAYER 3—16, 22.05, 24kHzMP3 files for USB memory:MPEG 1 AUDIO LAYER 2, 3—32,44.1, 48 kHzMPEG 2 AUDIO LAYER 2, 3—16,22.05, 24 kHzMPEG 2.5—8, 11.025, 12 kHzWMA files for WMA player:Ver. 7, 8, 9 CBR—32, 44.1, 48 kHzWMA files for USB memory:Ver. 9—HIGH PROFILE 32, 44.1, 48kHz

� The sound quality of MP3/WMA filesgenerally improves with higher bit rate-s. In order to achieve a reasonable lev-el of sound quality, discs recorded witha bit rate of at least 128 kbps are rec-ommended.

Playable bit ratesMP3 files for MP3 player:MPEG1 LAYER3—64 to 320 kbpsMPEG2 LSF LAYER3—64 to 160 kbpsMP3 files for USB memory:MPEG 1 AUDIO LAYER 2, 3—32 to320 kbpsMPEG 2 AUDIO LAYER 2, 3—32 to160 kbpsMPEG 2.5—32 to 160 kbpsWMA files for WMA player:Ver. 7, 8 CBR—48 to 192 kbpsVer. 9 CBR—48 to 320 kbpsWMA files for USB memory:Ver. 9—HIGH PROFILE 32 to 320kbps, VBR (Variable Bit Rate)

� The MP3/WMA player does not playback MP3/WMA files from discs re-corder using packet write data transfer(UDF format). Discs should be re-corded using “pre−mastering” softwarerather than packet−write software.

� M3u playlists are not compatible withthe audio player.

� MP3i (MP3 interactive) and MP3PROformats are not compatible with the au-dio player.

� The player is compatible with VBR(Variable Bit Rate).

� When playing back files recorded asVBR (Variable Bit Rate) files, the playtime will not be correctly displayed iffast−forward or reverse operations areused.

� It is not possible to check folders thatdo not include MP3/WMA files.

� MP3/WMA files in folders up to 8 levelsdeep can be played. However, thestart of playback may be delayed whenusing discs containing numerous lev-els of folders. For this reason, we rec-ommend creating discs with no morethan two levels of folders.

Page 305: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

305

6U5161aX

001.mp3002.wma

Folder 1003.mp3Folder 2004.mp3005.wma

Folder 3006.mp3

� The play order of the compact disc withthe structure shown above is as fol-lows:

001.mp3 002.wma . . . 006.mp3

� MP3/WMA player—It is possible toplay up to 192 folders or 255 files onone disc.

� USB memory—It is possible to play upto 999 folders, 255 files per folder or65,025 files in device.

� The order changes depending on thePC and MP3/WMA encoding softwareyou use.

CD−R and CD−RW discs� CD−R/CD−RW discs that have not

been subject to the “finalizing process”(a process that allows discs to beplayed on a conventional CD player)cannot be played.

� It may not be possible to play CD−R/CD−RW discs recorded on a musicCD recorder or a personal computerbecause of disc characteristics,scratches or dirt on the disc, or dirt,condensation, etc. on the lens of theunit.

� It may not be possible to play discs re-corded on a personal computer de-pending on the application settings andthe environment. Record with the cor-rect format. (For details, contact theappropriate application manufacturersof the applications.)

� CD−R/CD−RW discs may be damagedby direct exposure to sunlight, hightemperatures or other storage condi-tions. The unit may be unable to playsome damaged discs.

� If you insert a CD−RW disc into theMP3/WMA player, playback will beginmore slowly than with a conventionalCD or CD−R disc.

� Recordings on CD−R/CD−RW cannotbe played using the DDCD (DoubleDensity CD) system.

Page 306: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AUDIO/VIDEO SYSTEM

306

TERMSPacket write—This is a general term that describes theprocess of writing data on−demand toCD−R, etc., in the same way that data iswritten to floppy or hard discs.

ID3 Tag—This is a method of embedding track−re-lated information in an MP3 file. This em-bedded information can include the tracktitle, the artist’s name, the album title, themusic genre, the year of production, com-ments and other data. The contents canbe freely edited using software with ID3 tagediting functions. Although the tags are re-stricted to the number of characters, the in-formation can be viewed when the track isplayed back.

WMA Tag—WMA files can contain a WMA tag that isused in the same way as an ID3 tag. WMAtags carry information such as track title,artist name.

ISO 9660 format—This is the international standard for theformatting of CD−ROM folders and files.For the ISO 9660 format, there are two lev-els of regulations.

Level 1:

The file name is in 8.3 format (8 characterfile names, with a 3 character file exten-sion. File names must be composed ofone−byte capital letters and numbers. The“_” symbol may also be included.)

Level 2:

The file name can have up to 31 characters(including the separation mark “.” and fileextension). Each folder must contain few-er than 8 hierarchies.

m3u—Playlists created using “WINAMP” soft-ware have a playlist file extension (.m3u).

MP3—MP3 is an audio compression standard de-termined by a working group (MPEG) ofthe ISO (International Standard Organiza-tion). MP3 compresses audio data toabout 1/10 the size of that on conventionaldiscs.

WMA—WMA (Windows Media Audio) is an audiocompression format developed byMicrosoft�. It compresses files into a sizesmaller than that of MP3 files. Thedecoding formats for WMA files are Ver. 7,8, and 9.

Page 307: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 8

AIR CONDITIONING

307

AIR CONDITIONING

� Automatic air conditioning controls 308. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 308: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

308

Operations such as changing the air outlets or fan speed are carried out on the screen.To display the air conditioning control screen, push the “MENU” button on the RemoteTouch and select “Climate”.

1 Driver side temperature display (In degrees Fahrenheit or Centi-grade)

2 Outside temperature display (In degrees Fahrenheit or Centi-grade) 318. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

3 “DUAL” (Temperature setting mode changebutton) 310, 312. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

4 Air flow control buttons 312. . . . 5 Passenger side temperature dis-

play (In degrees Fahrenheit or Centi-grade)

6 Fan speed control buttons311. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

7 Windshield wiper de−icer button316. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

8 “A/C” 314. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Air intake control button

311, 313. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Rear window defogger button

317. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Windshield air flow button

314. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 “AUTO” button 310. . . . . . . . . . . .

Automatic air conditioning controls

Page 309: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

309

13 “PASSENGER TEMP” buttons(Passenger side temperature controlbutton) (Only for the independent mode thatdisplay shows “DUAL”; mainly forfront passenger and secondarily fordriver) 310, 312. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

14 “TEMP” buttons(Driver side temperature control but-ton) (At the independent mode thatdisplay shows “DUAL”; mainly fordriver and secondarily for front pas-senger)(At the linked mode that display doesnot show “DUAL”; for driver)

310, 312. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

(a) Climate controlAir outlets and fan speed are automati-cally adjusted according to the temper-ature setting.The “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch must be in ON <IGNITIONON> mode.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U7001LS

2. Select “Climate” to display the airconditioning control screen.

NOTICE

To prevent the 12−volt battery frombeing discharged, do not leave the airconditioning on longer than neces-sary when the hybrid system is off<the engine is not running>.

Page 310: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

310

INFORMATION� During use, various odors from in-

side and outside the vehicle mayenter into and accumulate in the airconditioning system. This maythen cause odor to be emitted fromthe vents.

� To reduce potential odors from oc-curring:

� It is recommended that the airconditioning system be set tooutside air mode prior to turningthe vehicle off.

� The start timing of the blowermay be delayed for a short peri-od of time immediately after theair conditioning system isstarted in automatic operationmode.

By pushing the switch above, you canoperate the voice command system.For the operation of the voice commandsystem and the command, see pages 50and 54.

(b) Using automatic air conditioningsystem� Switching to automatic operation

mode

Push the “AUTO” button.The air conditioning system begins to op-erate. Air outlets and fan speed are auto-matically adjusted according to the tem-perature setting.

Push and hold “�OFF” button to turn theair conditioning system off.

� Setting the vehicle interior tempera-ture

Push the “�” button on “TEMP” to in-crease the temperature and “�” to de-crease the temperature.

Page 311: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

311

“DUAL” is used to set the temperaturesindependently for the driver’s seat andfront passenger seat.

When the “DUAL” indicator is on, the tem-perature for the driver’s seat and front pas-senger seat can be adjusted separately.

� Switching the air intake control toautomatic mode

Push the air intake control button toswitch to automatic mode.The air conditioning system automaticallyswitches between outside air and recircu-lated air modes.

INFORMATIONYou can adjust the setting in automat-ic mode. (See page 420.)

(c) Adjusting the settings manually� Setting the fan speed

To turn on the air conditioning systemand adjust the fan speed, push the “�”button on fan speed control button toincrease the fan speed and push the “�OFF” button to decrease the fan speed.To turn the fan off, push and hold the “�OFF” button.

Using the screen—

1 Fan speed at low2 Fan speed at high

Page 312: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

312

� Setting the vehicle interior tempera-ture

To adjust the temperature setting, pushthe “�” button on “TEMP” to increasethe temperature and push the “�” but-ton to decrease the temperature.When the “DUAL” indicator is on, the tem-perature for the driver’s seat and front pas-senger seat can be adjusted separately.

� Switching the air outlets

To change the air outlets, push the“MODE” button.The air outlets used are switched eachtime the button is pushed.

Using the screen—

1 Panel2 Bi−level3 Floor4 Floor/windshield

The air flow shown on the display indicatesthe following.

� Air flows to the upper body (Panel)

Page 313: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

313

� Air flows to the upper body and feet(Bi−level)

� Air flows to the feet (Floor)

� Air flows to the feet and the wind-shield defogger operates (Floor/wind-shield)

� Switching between outside air andrecirculated air modes

� Type A

Push the air intake control button.The mode switches between outside airmode (the indicator is off), “AUTO” modeand recirculated air mode (the indicator ison) each time the button is pushed.

� Type B

Push the air intake control button.The mode switches between recirculatedair mode and outside air mode each timethe button is pushed.

Page 314: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

314

(d) Defogging the windshield

The air conditioning system operatesautomatically.

Recirculated air mode will automaticallyswitch to outside air mode. It is not pos-sible to return to recirculated air modewhen the switch is on.

CAUTION

To prevent the windshield from fog-ging upDo not use the windshield air flowbutton during cool air operation inextremely humid weather. The differ-ence between the temperature of theoutside air and that of the windshieldcan cause the outer surface of thewindshield to fog up, blocking yourvision.

(e) Adjusting the position of and open-ing and closing the air outlets

� Front center outlets

1 Direct air flow to the left or right, upor down

2 Turn the knob to open or close thevent

� Front side outlets

1 Direct air flow to the left or right, upor down

2 Turn the knob to open or close thevent

Page 315: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

315

� Rear outlets

1 Direct air flow to the left or right, upor down

2 Turn the knob to open or close thevent

INFORMATION� Operation of the air conditioning

system in Eco drive mode (ve-hicles with hybrid system)

In Eco drive mode, the air condi-tioning system is controlled as fol-lows to prioritize fuel efficiency:

� Engine speed and compressoroperation controlled to restrictheating/cooling capacity

� Fan speed restricted when auto-matic mode is selected

To improve air conditioning perfor-mance, perform the following op-erations:

� Adjust the fan speed

� Turn off Eco drive mode

� Customization (vehicles with hy-brid system)

The air conditioning control re-striction of Eco drive mode can bechanged to the same setting asthat used in normal drive mode.For details, refer to the “Owner’sManual”.

Changing the air conditioning re-striction will slightly reduce theEco drive mode’s fuel efficiencywhen compared to before thechange was made.

� Registering air conditioning set-tings to electronic keys

� Unlocking the vehicle using anelectronic key and turning the“POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch to ON <IGNITIONON> mode will recall that key’sregistered air conditioning set-tings.

� When the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is turnedoff, the current air conditioningsettings will automatically beregistered to the electronic keythat was used to unlock the ve-hicle.

The system may not operate cor-rectly if more than one electronickey is in the vicinity or if thesmart access system with push−button start is used to unlock apassenger door.Settings for the electronic keyand the corresponding door canbe changed. Contact your Lexusdealer.

� Using automatic mode

Fan speed is adjusted automatical-ly according to the temperaturesetting and ambient conditions.As a result, the following may oc-cur:

� Immediately after the button ispushed, the fan may stop for awhile until warm or cool air isready to flow.

� Using the system in recirculatedair mode

The windows will fog up more easi-ly if recirculated air mode is usedfor an extended period.

Page 316: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

316

� Switching between outside air andrecirculated air modes

Recirculated air mode or outsideair mode may be automaticallyswitched to in accordance with thetemperature setting and the insidetemperature.

� Window defogger feature

Recirculated air mode may auto-matically switch to outside airmode in situations where the win-dows need to be defogged.

� When outside air temperature isbelow 32�F (0�C)

The cooling and dehumidificationfunction may not operate evenwhen “A/C” is on.

� When the indicator light on “A/C”flashes

Select “A/C” to turn off the coolingand dehumidification function andturn it on again. There may be aproblem in the air conditioningsystem if the indicator light contin-ues to flash. Turn the air condition-ing system off and have it in-spected by your Lexus dealer.

� Automatic air intake change mode

In automatic mode, the system au-tomatically switches between re-circulated air and outside airmodes according to whether thesystem detects harmful sub-stances such as exhaust gas in theair outside.If you select automatic mode whenonly the fans are operating, the airconditioning system will turn onautomatically.

(f) Windshield wiper de−icer (ifequipped)This feature is used to prevent ice frombuilding up on the windshield and wiperblades.

The windshield wiper de−icer can be oper-ated when the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is in ON <IGNI-TION ON> mode.

Turns the windshield wiper de−iceron/off.The windshield wiper de−icer will automat-ically turn off after approximately 15 min-utes.

CAUTION

When the windshield wiper de−icer isonDo not touch the lower part of thewindshield or the side of the front pil-lars, as the surfaces can become veryhot and burn you.

Page 317: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

317

(g) Rear window and outside rear viewmirror defogging

To turn the electric rear window andoutside rear view mirror defogger on,push the button above.The “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch must be in ON <IGNITIONON> mode.

The thin heater wires on the inside of therear window and the heater panels in theoutside rear view mirrors will quickly clearthe surface.

Keep your hands off the mirror faces whenthe system is on.

The indicator light is on when the defoggeris operating.

CAUTION

When the outside rear view mirror de-foggers are on, do not touch the out-side surface of the rear view mirror asit can become very hot and burn you.

The defoggers will automatically turn offafter 15 to 60 minutes. The operation timechanges according to the ambient temper-ature and vehicle speed.

If further defrosting or defogging is de-sired, simply actuate the switch again.When the surface has cleared, push thebutton once again to turn the defogger off.Continuous use may cause the 12−voltbattery to discharge, especially duringstop−and−go driving. The defogger is notdesigned to dry rain water or to melt snow.

If the outside rear view mirrors are heavilycoated with ice, use a spray de−icer beforeoperating the system.

NOTICE

� When cleaning the inside of therear window, be careful not toscratch or damage the heater wiresor connectors.

� To prevent the12−volt battery frombeing discharged, turn the switchoff when the hybrid system is off<the engine is not running>.

Page 318: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

AIR CONDITIONING

318

(h) Outside temperature display

Outside temperature is displayed onthe screen.The displayed temperature ranges from−40�F (−40�C) up to 122�F (50�C).

If the temperature shows “− −” or “E”, takeyour vehicle to your Lexus dealer.

In the following situations, the correct out-side temperature may not be displayed, orthe display may take longer than normal tochange.

� When stopped, or driving at lowspeeds (less than 15.5 mph [25 km/h])

� When the outside temperature haschanged suddenly (at the entrance/exitof a garage, tunnel, etc.)

Page 319: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 9

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

319

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

� Rear view monitor system 320. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 320: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

320

The rear view monitor system assiststhe driver by displaying an image of theview behind the vehicle while backingup. The image is displayed in reverseon the screen. This allows the image toappear in the same manner as that ofthe rear view mirror.To display the rear view image on thescreen, shift the shift lever to “R” whenthe “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is in ON <IGNITION ON>mode.If you move the shift lever out of the “R”, thescreen returns to the previous screen. Op-erating another function of the navigationsystem will display another screen.

Vehicles with intuitive parking assist−sensor — when the intuitive parking as-sist−sensors are turned on and an ob-stacle is detected in front of or behindyour vehicle, a warning appears on theright top of the rear view monitor. Fordetails, see “Intuitive parking assist” onpage 338.

The rear view monitor system is a supple-ment device intended to assist back up.When backing up, be sure to check behindand all around the vehicle visually.

CAUTION

� Never depend on the rear viewmonitor system entirely whenbacking up. Always make sureyour intended path is clear.Use caution, just as you wouldwhen backing up any vehicle.

� Never back up while looking only atthe screen. The image on thescreen is different from actualconditions. Depicted distancesbetween objects and flat surfaceswill differ from actual distance. Ifyou back up while looking only atthe screen, you may hit a vehicle, aperson or an object. When backingup, be sure to check behind and allaround the vehicle visually andwith mirrors before proceeding.

� Do not use the system when theback door is not completelyclosed.

� Use your own eyes to confirm thevehicle’s surroundings, as the dis-played image may become faint ordark, and moving images will bedistorted, or not entirely visiblewhen the outside temperature islow. When backing up, be sure tocheck behind and all around the ve-hicle visually and with mirror be-fore proceeding.

� Do not use the system in the follow-ing cases:� On icy or slick road surfaces, or

in snow.� When using tire chains or emer-

gency tires.� On roads that are not flat or

straight, such as curves or slo-pes.

Rear view monitor system —

Page 321: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

321

NOTICE

� If the back of the vehicle is hit, theposition and mounting angle of thecamera may change. Be sure tohave the camera’s position andmounting angle checked at yourLexus dealer.

� As the camera has a water proofconstruction, do not detach, disas-semble or modify it. This maycause incorrect operation.

� Do not strongly rub the cameralens. If the camera lens isscratched, it can not transmit aclear image.

� If the temperature changes rapidly,such as when hot water is pouredon the vehicle in cold weather, thesystem may not operate normally.

� Do not expose the camera tostrong impact as this may cause amalfunction.

� Do not allow organic solvent, carwax, window cleaner or glass coatto adhere to the camera. If this hap-pens, wipe it off as soon as pos-sible.

� When washing the vehicle, do notapply intensive bursts of water tothe camera or camera area. Doingso may result in the camera mal-functioning.

� When replacing the tires, pleaseconsult your Lexus dealer. If youreplace the tires, the area dis-played on the screen may change.

INFORMATIONIf the camera lens becomes dirty, itcannot transmit a clear image. If wa-ter droplets, snow, or mud adhere tothe lens, rinse with water and wipewith a soft cloth. If the lens is ex-tremely dirty, wash it with a mildcleanser and rinse.

Page 322: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

322

� Area displayed on screenImage is displayed approximately levelon screen.

Corners of bumper

The area detected by the camera is limi-ted. The camera does not detect ob-jects which are close to either corner ofthe bumper or under the bumper.

The area displayed on the screen mayvary according to vehicle orientation orroad conditions.

Page 323: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

323

� The rear view monitor system cam-era

The rear view monitor system camera is lo-cated on the back door as shown in the il-lustration.

In the following cases, it may become diffi-cult to see the images on the screen, evenwhen the system is functioning.

� In the dark (for example, at night)

� When the temperature near the lens ishigh or low

� When water droplets are adhering tothe camera, or when humidity is high(for example, when it rains)

� When foreign matter (for example,snow or mud) is adhering to the camera

� When the camera has scratches or dirton it

� When the sun or the beam of head-lights is shining directly into the cameralens

NOTICE

The camera uses a special lens. Thedistance of the image that appears onthe screen differs from the actual dis-tance.

If a bright light (for example, sunlight re-flected off the vehicle body) is picked up bythe camera, the smear effect∗ peculiar tothe camera may occur.∗: Smear effect—A phenomenon that oc-curs when a bright light (for example, sun-light reflected off the vehicle body) ispicked up by the camera; when trans-mitted by the camera, the light source ap-pears to have a vertical streak above andbelow it.

When the camera is used under fluores-cent lights, sodium lights, or mercury lightsetc., the lights and the illuminated areasmay appear to flicker.

Page 324: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM

324

Page 325: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 10

SIDE MONITOR

325

SIDE MONITOR

� Side monitor 326. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 326: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

326

The side monitor assists the driver inchecking the safety of the vehicle’s sur-roundings by displaying an image of theview in front of and to the side of the frontpassenger side of the vehicle. The sidecamera is mounted on the underside of thefront passenger side outside rear view mir-ror.

The side monitor can be activated evenwhen the outside rear view mirrors arefolded.

CAUTION

� Always make sure to check allaround the vehicle with your owneyes when driving.

� Due to the property of the side cam-era lens, the position of and dis-tance to people or objects dis-played differs from actual positionand distance. (See page 328.)

� Never depend on the side monitoronly. Use caution just as youwould when driving any other ve-hicle.

� Never drive while looking only atthe screen as the image on thescreen is different from actualconditions. If you drive while look-ing only at the screen, you may hita person or an object, resulting inan accident. When driving, be sureto check the vehicle’s surround-ings with your own eyes and the ve-hicle’s mirrors.

� Do not use the side monitor in thefollowing cases:� On icy or slick road surfaces, or

in snow� When using tire chains or emer-

gency tires� When the hood or the front pas-

senger door is not completelyclosed

� On roads that are not flat, suchas slopes

� When the outside temperature islow, the displayed image may be-come faint or dark. Moving imageswill be distorted or not entirely vis-ible, so be sure to check the ve-hicle’s surroundings with yourown eyes and the vehicle’s mirrorswhile driving.

NOTICE

When replacing the tires, please con-sult your Lexus dealer. If you replacethe tires, the area displayed on thescreen may change.

Side monitor —

Page 327: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

327

INFORMATION� The area displayed on the screen

may vary according to vehicle sta-tus or road conditions.

� The area of the image captured bythe side camera is limited. Theside camera does not display ob-jects too close to or directly underthe corners of the bumpers on thefront passenger side.

� Due to the property of the sidecamera lens, the perceived dis-tance from images that appear onthe screen differs from the actualdistance.

� In the following cases, it may be-come difficult to see the images onthe screen, but this is not a mal-function:

� In the dark (for example, at night)

� When the temperature near thelens is high or low

� When there are water droplets onthe camera lens, or when humid-ity is high (for example, when itrains)

� When foreign matter such as mudis stuck to the side camera

� When the camera has scratchesor dirt on it

� When the sun or the beam ofheadlights is shining directlyinto the camera lens

� The following symptoms may oc-cur, but do not indicate a malfunc-tion:

� The camera may fog up when hu-midity is high (for example, whenit rains).

� When driving at night, ambientlights such as the lights of the ve-hicles ahead and building light-ing may be reflected into theimage.

� The center or four corners of theimage may decrease in definition.

� As the procedure is the same, fol-low the instructions for navigationscreen adjustment to adjust theside monitor. (See page 36.)

� When the outside rear view mirrorsare folded, the mirror base ob-structs the side camera’s view. Inthis case, the driver cannot use theside monitor to check the area infront of the vehicle.

Page 328: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

328

<Area of the image captured by the sidecamera>

Objects detected by theside camera

<Display>

Side camera capture range

The front passenger side of the vehicle isdisplayed on the screen.

� When a 3−dimensional object isnear the vehicle

If a 3−dimensional object such as an over-hanging wall is present near the vehicle,observe the following precautions to avoida collision:

— Area displayed on thescreen

Page 329: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

329

WHEN THE COURSE IS NEAR AN OB-STACLE<Display>

<Vehicle status>

Overhanging wall

Wall shown on the display

On the display, it appears that the vehiclewill not hit the wall. In reality, the overhang-ing part of the wall is in the way, and the ve-hicle may collide with it. When the courseis close to an obstacle, be sure to checkthe vehicle’s surroundings with your owneyes and the vehicle’s mirrors.

Page 330: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

330

� Side camera

NOTICE

Observe the following precautions toensure that the side monitor func-tions properly:

� Do not hit the camera or subject itto strong impacts as this maycause its position and mountingangle to change.

� As the camera is water proof, donot detach, disassemble or modifyit. Doing so may cause incorrectoperation.

� Do not scrub the camera lensroughly or clean it with a hardbrush or abrasive cleaner. Doingso may damage the lens and ad-versely affect the image.

� As the camera cover is resin, donot allow organic solvent, car wax,window cleaner or glass coatingagent to adhere to it. If this hap-pens, wipe clean as soon as pos-sible.

� Do not expose the side camera tosudden temperature changes suchas by pouring hot water on the ve-hicle in cold weather.

� If the side camera is hit, its positionand mounting angle may change.Be sure to have the side camerachecked by your Lexus dealer.

� Be careful when driving on roughroads as the surface of the cameramay be damaged by flying stonesor other debris.

� When washing the vehicle, do notapply intensive bursts of water tothe camera or camera area. Doingso may result in the camera mal-functioning.

INFORMATIONIf the camera lens becomes dirty, itcannot transmit a clear image. If wa-ter droplets, snow, or mud adhere tothe lens, rinse with water and wipewith a soft cloth. If the lens is ex-tremely dirty, wash it with a mildcleanser and rinse.

Page 331: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

331

If a bright light (for example, sunlight re-flected off the vehicle body) is picked up bythe side camera, the smear effect∗ peculiarto CCD cameras may occur.∗: Smear effect is a phenomenon that oc-curs when a bright light (for example, sun-light reflected off the vehicle body) ispicked up by the camera; when trans-mitted by the camera, the light source ap-pears to have a vertical streak above andbelow it.

When the camera is used under fluores-cent lights, sodium lights, or mercury lightsetc., the lights and the illuminated areasmay appear to flicker.

To display the side view, push the sidecamera button with the “POWER”<“ENGINE START STOP”> switch inACCESSORY or ON <IGNITION ON>mode and vehicle speed at 7 mph (12km/h) or less.� Pushing the side camera button again

changes the screen back to the pre-viously displayed screen, such as navi-gation screen. Each push of the buttonchanges the screen as follows:

Navigation or other display

Side view monitor display

� If the side camera button is pushedwhen the rear view monitor system isdisplayed, the side monitor will appear.

— Activating the sidemonitor

Page 332: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

332

� Cancelation of the side monitorIn the following situations, the side monitorwill be canceled:

When vehicle speed exceeds approxi-mately 7 mph (12 km/h)

When the side camera button is pushed

When the shift lever is shifted to “R”.

Any of the mode buttons on the RemoteTouch, such as “MENU” is pushed.

The image captured by the side camera isdisplayed on the screen.

This image can be used to help check thesafety of the front passenger side of the ve-hicle when making a turn to that side, aswell as when starting off and stopping.

— Side monitor

Page 333: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

333

� Button on the screen

1 Display area buttonSelecting this button changes betweenoverall view and enlarged front view. (Seepage 334.)2 Automatic display button

Selecting this button puts the side monitorin automatic display mode.

� Select this button to turn automatic dis-play mode on/off.

� The indicator on the button illuminatesduring automatic display mode.

(a) Automatic display modeIn addition to being able to display the sideview using the side camera button, auto-matic display mode is available. In auto-matic display mode, the side monitor is ac-tivated automatically according to vehiclespeed.

In automatic mode, the side monitor willautomatically appear in the following situa-tions:

� When the shift lever is shifted to a for-ward driving position or “N”

� When vehicle speed is reduced toapproximately 6 mph (10 km/h) or lesswith the shift lever in any position otherthan “R”

� Setting automatic display modeSelect the automatic display button.

Side monitor (See page 331.)

Page 334: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

334

(b) Display area modesThe side view monitor system has the fol-lowing 2 display area modes:

Overall display mode:

<Overall display mode>

This default mode displays the entire viewcaptured by the camera.

<Enlarged front view mode>

This mode can be used when an enlargedfront view is needed.

� This mode is not available when theoutside rear view mirrors are folded.

� Changing display area modesSelect the display area button.

� Each time the button is selected, themode will change as follows:

Overall display mode

Enlarged front view mode

� When the outside rear view mirrors arefolded, enlarged front view mode is notavailable. (The display area button willnot be displayed on the screen.)

� If the outside rear view mirrors arefolded when the screen is in enlargedfront view mode, the screen will auto-matically change to overall displaymode. After changing to overall dis-play mode, the screen will not return toenlarged front view mode even if themirrors are extended.

Page 335: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

335

CAUTION

When the side monitor is in enlargedfront view mode, the target objectmay not be shown on the screen.Even if the object is not visible, do notreadjust the steering wheel or steeroutside the guide lines until the ve-hicle passes the object as this mayresult in a collision.

In the following situations, be sure to per-form the initialization procedure:

� When the 12−volt battery is discon-nected

� When the side monitor changes to thesystem initialization screen due to12−volt battery discharge

<System initialization screen>

— When the 12−volt battery is disconnected or the systeminitialization screen appears on the display

Page 336: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SIDE MONITOR

336

� Initialization proceduresPerform either of the following procedures:

� With the vehicle stopped in a safeplace, turn the steering wheel all theway to the left, then all the way to theright. (It does not matter which direc-tion you turn the wheel to first.)

� Drive on a straight, uncongested roadfor approximately 5 minutes or more.

When the screen returns to the original dis-play, correction is complete.

NOTICE

If the initialization screen remains onafter performing initialization proce-dures, have the vehicle inspected byyour Lexus dealer.

Select “?” on the initialization screen toshow the help screen.

When the procedure shown on the displayhas been performed and the screen re-turns to the original display, the setting iscomplete.

If the initialization screen or the helpscreen remains on, have the system in-spected by your Lexus dealer.

Selecting “OK” will return the display tothe initialization screen.

Page 337: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 11

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

337

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

� Intuitive parking assist 338. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 338: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

338

The distance to obstacles measured bythe sensors is communicated via the dis-play and a buzzer when parallel parking ormaneuvering into a garage. Always checkthe surrounding area when using this sys-tem.

� Types of sensors

1 Front corner sensors2 Rear corner sensors3 Rear center sensors

� Setting the intuitive parking assistmode

1. Push the menu switch.The multi−information display will changemodes to electronic features control mode.

2. Push the “ENTER” switch upwardsor downwards until the intuitive park-ing assist−sensor mark appears in themulti−information display.

Intuitive parking assist —

Page 339: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

339

3. Push the “ENTER” switch to select“ON”.The intuitive parking assist−sensor indica-tor will be displayed.

Each pushing of the switch turns the intu-itive parking assist−sensor on and off.

To turn on: Push the switch. The buzzersounds to inform the driver that the systemis operational.

To turn off: Push the switch again.

Push the menu switch to change to thenormal display.

When the sensors detect an obstacle, thegraphic is shown on the multi−informationdisplay and navigation display accordingto position and distance to the obstacle.

� Multi−information display

1 Front corner sensors operation2 Rear corner sensors operation3 Rear center sensors operation� Navigation displayWHEN THE VEHICLE IS MOVING FOR-WARDThe graphic is automatically displayedwhen an obstacle is detected. The screencan be set so that the graphic is not dis-played. (See page 421.)

WHEN THE VEHICLE IS MOVINGBACKWARDA simplified image is displayed on the rightupper corner of the screen when an ob-stacle is detected.

— Display

Page 340: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

340

When a sensor detects an obstacle, the direction of and the approximate distance to theobstacle are displayed and the buzzer sounds.

CORNER SENSORS

Level 1 2 3 4

Displayexample −

Buzzer − Medium Fast Continuous

CENTER SENSORS

Level 1 2 3 4

Displayexample

Buzzer Slow Medium Fast Continuous

� Detection level and approximate distance to an obstacle

Level 1 2 3 4

Front cornersensors −

2.0 to 1.6 ft.(60 to 47.5

cm)

1.6 to 1.2 ft.(47.5 to 35

cm)

1.2 ft. (35cm) or less

Rear cornersensors −

1.6 to 1.2 ft.(50 to 37.5

cm)

1.2 to 0.8 ft.(37.5 to 25

cm)

0.8 ft. (25cm) or less

Rear centersensors

4.9 to 2.0 ft.(150 to 60

cm)

2.0 to 1.5 ft.(60 to 45

cm)

1.5 to 1.2 ft.(45 to 35

cm)

1.2 ft. (35cm) or less

INFORMATIONSettings (e.g. buzzer volume) can bechanged. (See page 421.)

— The distance display and buzzer

Page 341: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

341

1 Approximately 2.0 ft. (60 cm)2 Approximately 1.6 ft. (50 cm)3 Approximately 4.9 ft. (150 cm)

The diagram shows the detection range ofthe sensors. Note that the sensors cannotdetect obstacles that are extremely closeto the vehicle.

The range of the sensors may change de-pending on the shape of the object etc.

� Certain vehicle conditions and the sur-rounding environment may affect theability of a sensor to correctly detect anobstacle. Particular instances wherethis may occur are listed below.

� There is dirt, snow or ice on a sen-sor.

� A sensor is frozen.

� A sensor is covered in any way.

� The vehicle is leaning considerablyto one side.

� On an extremely bumpy road, on anincline, on gravel, or on grass

� The vicinity of the vehicle is noisydue to vehicle horns, motorcycleengines, air brakes of large ve-hicles, or other loud noises produc-ing ultrasonic waves.

� There is another vehicle equippedwith parking assist sensors in the vi-cinity.

� A sensor is coated with a sheet ofspray or heavy rain.

� The vehicle is equipped with a fend-er pole or radio antenna.

� Towing eyelets are installed.

� A bumper or sensor receives astrong impact.

� The vehicle is approaching a tall orright−angled curb.

� In harsh sunlight or intense coldweather.

� A non−genuine Lexus suspension(lowered suspension, etc.) isinstalled.

In addition to the examples above, thereare instances in which, because of theirshapes, signs and other objects may bejudged by a sensor to be closer than theyare.

— Detection range of thesensors

— Sensor detectioninformation

Page 342: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

342

� The shape of the obstacle may preventa sensor from detecting it. Pay particu-lar attention to the following obstacles:

� Wires, fences, ropes, etc.

� Cotton, snow and other materialsthat absorb sound waves

� Sharply−angled objects

� Low obstacles

� Tall obstacles with upper sectionsprojecting outwards in the directionof your vehicle

CAUTION� Caution when using the intuitive

parking assist−sensorObserve the following precautions.Failing to do so may result in thevehicle being unable to be drivensafely and possibly cause an acci-dent.� Do not use the sensor at speeds

in excess of 6 mph (10 km/h).� Do not attach any accessories

within the sensor range.

NOTICE

Notes when washing the vehicle

Do not apply intensive bursts of wa-ter or steam to the sensor area.

Doing so may result in the sensormalfunctioning.

System malfunction

� An accident will affect the sensors,resulting in system failure.

� If the indicators remain on withouta beeping sound, the system maybe malfunctioning. Contact yourLexus dealer.

If an error is detected when the intuitiveparking assist−sensor is turned on, thevehicle symbol comes on or flasheswith beeping sounds.However, the sensors functioning properlycontinue their obstacle detection.

The intuitive parking assist−sensor failurewarning display is not given in either of thefollowing operations:

� Changing to another screen

� Turning off the main switch for the intu-itive parking assist−sensor

— Intuitive parkingassist−sensor failurewarning

Page 343: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

343

� When snowflakes or mud gets onthe sensors

� Multi−information display

If the failure warning does not go off evenafter the foreign matter is removed, the in-tuitive parking assist−sensor may be mal-functioning. Have it checked by yourLexus dealer.

� When the sensor is malfunctioning

� Multi−information display

If this message appears, have the intuitiveparking assist−sensor checked by yourLexus dealer.

As the intuitive parking assist−sensormight be malfunctioning in the follow-ing cases, have it checked by yourLexus dealer.� The indicator in the instrument cluster

does not come on and a beep does notsound even when the intuitive parkingassist−sensor main switch is turnedon.

� The warning comes on despite no ob-stacle around the vehicle.

Page 344: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INTUITIVE PARKING ASSIST

344

� CertificationFor vehicles sold in Canada.

This ISM device complies with Cana-dian ICES−001.

Cet appareil ISM est conforme a lanorme NMB−001 du Canada.

Page 345: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 12

SETUP

345

SETUP

� General settings 346. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (Used for language selection and the on/off settings of operation sounds and automatic screen change.)

� Clock settings 353. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (Used for changing time zones and the on/off settings of daylight saving time.)

� Voice settings 355. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (Voice guidance can be set.)

� Navigation settings 359. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (“Home” and “Preset Destinations” can be set and edited.)

� Detailed navigation settings 359. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (Average cruising speed, displayed screen contents, and POI icon categories can be set.)

� Telephone settings 368. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (Bluetooth� phones can be registered.)

� Audio settings 407. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (Settings are available for portable audio devices and Bluetooth� audio devices players.)

� Vehicle settings 415. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (Vehicle information can be set.)

� Other settings 423. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (Used for changing settings for Lexus Insider and XM� Sports and Stocks.)

Page 346: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

346

Used for language selection and the on/offsettings of operation sounds and automat-ic screen change.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U4001LS

2. Select “Setup”.

U10001LS

3. Select “General”.

4. Select the items to be set.5. Select “Save”.

General settings

Page 347: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

347

SCREENS FOR GENERAL SETTINGS

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed.

No. Function

1You can change the language.(See “� Selecting a language” onpage 348.)

2

Rear system lock* can be set to“On” or “Off”. (See “� Rear sys-tem lock” on page 348.)

* : Vehicles with rear seat enter-tainment system

3

“On” or “Off” can be selected forautomatic screen changes fromthe audio/air conditioner screen tothe map. When “On” is selected,the screen will automatically re-turn to the map from the audio/airconditioner screen after 20 sec-onds.

4Keyboard layout can be changed.(See “� Selecting a keyboard lay-out” on page 349.)

5Distance unit can be changed.(See “� Unit of measurement” onpage 350.)

6 “On” or “Off” can be selected forselection sounds.

7 “On” or “Off” can be selected forpointer sounds.

8 “On” or “Off” can be selected forerror sounds.

9

The strength of the pull from thebuttons to the pointer can be ad-justed. (See “� Setting a feedbackforce” on page 350.)

10Pointer shape can be changed.(See “� Selecting the pointershape” on page 351.)

11Pointer size can be changed. (See“� Changing the pointer size” onpage 351.)

12The personal data can be deleted.(See “� Delete personal data” onpage 352.)

Page 348: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

348

� Selecting a languageYou can change the language.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “General” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Language”.

4. Select the desired button.The previous screen will be displayed.

5. Select “Save”.

� Rear system lock (with rear seat en-tertainment system)

If the vehicle is equipped with the rear seatentertainment system, the rear seat enter-tainment system can be locked to preventrear passengers from operating the enter-tainment system.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “General” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Rear System Lock”.4. Select “On” or “Off” and then select“Save”.“On”: The rear passengers cannot oper-ate the rear seat entertainment system.Only front passengers can operate thesystem.

“Off”: Both the front and rear passengerscan operate the rear seat entertainmentsystem.

Page 349: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

349

� Selecting a keyboard layoutKeyboard layout can be changed.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “General” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Keyboard Layout”.

4. Select “ABC” or “QWERTY” of“Keyboard Layout” to choose the key-board layout.5. Select “Save”.

LAYOUT TYPE

� “ABC” type

� “QWERTY” type

Page 350: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

350

� Unit of measurementDistance unit can be changed.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “General” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Unit of Measurement”.

4. Select “Kilometer” or “Mile”.5. Select “Save”.

INFORMATIONThis function is available only in En-glish or Spanish. To switch lan-guage, see “� Selecting a language”on page 348.

� Setting a feedback forceWhen the pointer moves close to a button,it will be automatically pulled onto that but-ton. The strength of this pull can be ad-justed.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “General” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Feedback Force”.

4. Select “+” or “−”.5. Select “OK”.

Page 351: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

351

� Selecting the pointer shapePointer shape can be changed.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “General” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Pointer Shape”.

4. Select the desired button.

: Change to an arrow.

: Change to a left hand.

: Change to a right hand.

: Display of the pointer can beturned off. (Even if display of the pointer isturned off, the pointer will appear on themap screen as “+”.)

5. Select “Save”.

� Changing the pointer sizePointer size can be changed.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “General” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Pointer Size”.

4. Select the desired button.5. Select “Save”.

Page 352: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

352

� Delete personal dataThe following personal data can be de-leted or returned to their default settings:

Maintenance conditions

Maintenance information “off” setting

Address book

Areas to avoid

Previous points

Route guidance

Route trace

Phonebook data

Call history data

Speed dial data

Voice tag data

Bluetooth� phone data

Volume setting

Details setting

This function is available only when the ve-hicle is not moving.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “General” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Delete Personal Data”.

4. Select “Delete”.

5. Select “Yes”.

Page 353: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

353

Used for changing time zones and the on/off settings of daylight saving time.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U4001LS

2. Select “Setup”.

U10002LS

3. Select “Clock”.

4. Select the items to be set.5. Select “Save”.

Clock settings

Page 354: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

354

SCREEN FOR CLOCK SETTINGS

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed.

No. Function

1 Time zone can be changed. (See“� Time zone” on page 354.)

2 “On” or “Off” can be selected fordaylight savings time.

3 “On” or “Off” can be selected forautomatic adjustment of the clock.

� Time zoneA time zone can be selected and GMT canbe set.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Clock” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select “Time Zone”.

4. Select the desired time zone.If you select “Other”, adjust the zonemanually.

5. Select “OK”.

Page 355: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

355

� Manual clock settingWhen “Auto adjust clock” is turned “Off”,the clock can be manually adjusted.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Clock” on the “Setup”screen.“Hours” “+”, “−”: Select “+” to set thetime forward one hour and “−” to set thetime back one hour.“Minutes” “+”, “−”: Select “+” to set thetime forward one minute and “−” to set thetime back one minute.“Minutes” “:00”: Rounds to the nearesthour∗

∗: e.g.1:00 to 1:29 → 1:00 1:30 to 1:59 → 2:00

3. Select “OK”.

Voice guidance can be set.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U4001LS

2. Select “Setup”.

U10003LS

3. Select “Voice”.

Voice settings

Page 356: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

356

4. Select the items to be set.5. Select “Save”.

SCREEN FOR VOICE SETTINGS

U10030LS

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed.

Page 357: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

357

No. Function

1The voice guidance volume canbe adjusted or switched off. (See“� Voice volume” on page 357.)

2 Voice guidance during route guid-ance can be set to “On” or “Off”.

3“On” or “Off” can be selected forvoice guidance when the audio/airconditioner is used.

4

Voice recognition prompt can beset to “On” or “Off”.

This setting can also be changedon the “Voice Menu” screen. (Seepage 50.)

5

When “On” is selected, the voicecommand system can be oper-ated without pressing the talkswitch more than once.

6

When using the traffic informationfunction, voice guidance can beset to “On” or “Off”. (See “� Traf-fic voice guidance” on page 358.)

7

When using the XM NavWea-ther� function, the severe weath-er warning can be set to “On” or“Off”.

8

Voice guidance projection can beset to the “Center” position or the“Driver” position. (See “� Voiceguidance speaker” on page 358.)

� Voice volumeThe voice guidance volume can be ad-justed or switched off.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Voice” on the “Setup”screen.

3. Select the desired level by selectingthe number.If voice guidance is not needed, select“Off” to disable the feature.

When selected the number or “Off” will behighlighted.

4. Select “Save”.

Page 358: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

358

� Traffic voice guidanceYou can receive congestion informationthrough voice guidance while being guidedto your destination.

To turn the “Traffic Voice Guidance” on:

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Voice” on the “Setup”screen.

U10031LS

3. Select “On” of the “Traffic VoiceGuidance”.4. Select “Save”.

INFORMATION� This function is available only in

English. To select English, see “�Selecting a language” on page 348.

� When the “Traffic Information” in-dicator is dimmed, “Auto AvoidTraffic”, “Traffic Voice Guidance”and “Show Free Flowing Traffic”will not operate.

� Voice guidance speakerThe projection position of voice guidancecan be adjusted.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Voice” on the “Setup”screen.

U10032LS

3. Select “Voice Guidance Speaker”.

4. Select “Center” or “Driver”.5. Select “Save”.

Page 359: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

359

Points or areas on the map can be register-ed.

On this screen, the following operationscan be performed.

No. Function

1 Sets home(See page 117.)

2 Sets preset destinations(See page 119.)

3 Sets address book(See page 122.)

4 Sets area to avoid(See page 128.)

5 Deletes previous destinations(See page 133.)

6 Detailed navigation settings(See page 359.)

Average cruising speed, displayed screencontents, and POI icon categories can beset.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U4001LS

2. Select “Setup”.

U4002LS

3. Select “Navi.”.

Navigation settings Detailed navigation settings

Page 360: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

360

4. Select “Detailed Navi. Settings”.

5. Select the items to be set.6. Select “Save”.

SCREENS FOR NAVIGATION SET-TINGS

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed.

No. Function

1Average cruising speed can beset. (See “� Driving speeds” onpage 361.)

2 The automatic input function canbe set to “On” or “Off”.

3During route guidance, voice guid-ance for the next street name canbe set to “On” or “Off”.

4

“On” or “Off” can be selected toreroute the guidance route auto-matically to avoid heavy conges-tion.

5When “On” is selected, freelyflowing traffic can be shown withthe arrow.

Page 361: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

361

No. Function

6

Displayed POI icon categories canbe set. (See “� POI categorychange (Select POI icons)” onpage 364.)

7

Buttons displayed on the mapscreen when “��Off” is selectedcan be set. (See “� Screen layoutfunction (“��Off” function)” onpage 365.)

8

The current vehicle position markcan be adjusted manually. Miscal-culation of the distance caused bytire replacement can also be ad-justed. (See “� Current position/tire change calibration” on page365.)

9

Display of pop−up information canbe set to “On” or “Off”. (See “�Pop−up information” on the page367.)

� Driving speedsThe speed that is used for the calculationof the estimated travel time and the esti-mated arrival time can be set.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” onthe “Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Driving Speeds”.

5. Select or to set the averagevehicle speeds for “Residential”, “MainStreets”, and “Freeways”.To set the default speeds, select “De-fault”.

6. After setting of the desired speedsis completed, select “Save”.

Page 362: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

362

INFORMATION� The displayed time to the destina-

tion is the approximate drivingtime that is calculated based on theselected speeds and the actualposition along the guidance route.

� The time shown on the screen mayvary greatly depending on prog-ress along the route, which may beaffected by conditions such astraffic jams and construction work.

� It is possible to display up to 99hours 59 minutes.

� Auto avoid trafficThe guidance route automaticallychanges to another route to avoid heavycongestion.

To turn the “Auto Avoid Traffic” on:

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” onthe “Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select “On” of the “Auto Avoid Traf-fic”.5. Select “Save”.

When congestion information about theguidance route has been received, ascreen will appear to ask you whether toreroute to avoid the congestion.

If you wish to reroute, select “Yes”. Anoth-er route to allow you to avoid the conges-tion will appear.

If you do not wish to reroute, select “No”.

Page 363: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

363

INFORMATIONWhen the “Traffic Information” indi-cator is dimmed, “Auto Avoid Traf-fic”, “Traffic Voice Guidance” and“Show Free Flowing Traffic” will notoperate.

� Show free flowing trafficFreely flowing traffic is shown with the ar-row.

To turn the “Show Free Flowing Traffic” on:

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” onthe “Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select “On” of the “Show Free Flow-ing Traffic”.5. Select “Save”.

INFORMATIONWhen the “Traffic Information” indi-cator is dimmed, “Auto Avoid Traf-fic”, “Traffic Voice Guidance” and“Show Free Flowing Traffic” will notoperate.

Page 364: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

364

� POI category change (Select POI icons)

Select from among the 6 icons displayedon the “Customize POI Icons” screen, sothat setting of the icons to be displayed onthe map screen can be done easily.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” onthe “Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Customize POI Icons”.

5. Select the category button to bechanged.

6. Select the desired group.

If the desired POI category is not on thescreen, select “List All Categories” to listall POI categories.

7. Select the desired category.8. Select “OK”.

Page 365: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

365

� Screen layout function (“��Off”function)

Each screen buttons and current streetname on the map screen can be displayedor hidden.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” onthe “Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select ““��Off” Function”.

5. Select the button to be turned off.The button becomes dimmed.To set the default, select “Default”.

6. Select “Save”.

� Current position/tire change cal-ibration

The current vehicle position mark can beadjusted manually. Miscalculation of thedistance caused by tire replacement canalso be adjusted.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” onthe “Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Calibration”.

5. Select the desired button.

INFORMATIONFor additional information on the ac-curacy of a current vehicle position,see “Limitations of the navigationsystem” on page 426.

Page 366: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

366

POSITION/DIRECTION CALIBRATIONWhen driving, the current vehicle positionmark will be automatically corrected byGPS signals. If GPS reception is poor dueto location, you can manually adjust thecurrent vehicle position mark.

1. Select “Position / Direction”.

2. Select the 8 directional button tomove the cursor to the desired pointon the map.3. Select “OK”.

4. Select either the or to ad-

just the direction of the current vehicleposition mark.5. Select “OK”.The map will be displayed.

Page 367: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

367

TIRE CHANGE CALIBRATIONThe tire change calibration function will beused when replacing the tires. This func-tion will adjust the miscalculation causedby the circumference difference betweenthe old and new tires. If this procedure isnot performed when the tires are replaced,the current vehicle position mark may beincorrectly displayed.

To perform a distance calibration pro-cedure, select “Tire Change” on the“Calibration” screen.The message appears and the quick dis-tance calibration is automatically started.A few seconds later, a map will be dis-played.

� Pop−up informationWhen the “Pop−up information” is turnedon, the pop−up information will be dis-played.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Navi.” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Detailed Navi. Settings” onthe “Navigation Settings” screen.

4. Select “Pop−up Information”.

5. Select “On” or “Off”.6. Select “Save”.

Page 368: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

368

When the “Pop−up Information” is turnedoff, the following messages will not be dis-played.

This message appears when the system isin the POI mode and the map scale is over0.5 miles (1 km).

The message appears when the map isswitched to the dual map screen mode.

“Telephone settings” can be changedon the “Phone settings” screen.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U4001LS

2. Select “Setup”.

U10004LS

3. Select “Phone”.

Telephone settings —

Page 369: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

369

Please refer to the following pages foreach setting.

You can adjust the voice and ring vol-ume.

1. Select “Volume”.

2. Change each setting according tothe following procedures.3. When you complete all settings, se-lect “Save”.

Automatic volume settings for highspeedThe system will automatically increase thevolume by one step up when the speed ex-ceeds 50 mph (80 km/h).

— Volume setting

Page 370: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

370

� Voice volume setting1. Select “Voice Volume”.

2. Select “–” or “+” to adjust the voicevolume.3. Select “OK”.

� Ring volume setting1. Select “Ring Volume”.

2. Select “–” or “+” to adjust the ringvolume.3. Select “OK”.

� Initializing the settingsYou can initialize the settings.1. Select “Default”.

2. Select “Yes”.

Page 371: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

371

“Manage phone” is accessed from the“Connect Phone” screen.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Setup”.3. Select “Phone”.

4. Select “Manage Phone”.

Please refer to the following pages foreach setting.

� Registering a Bluetooth� phone

1. Select “(add new)” to register yourcellular phone to the system.

2. When this screen is displayed, inputthe passcode displayed on the screeninto the phone.For the operation of the phone, see themanual that comes with your cellularphone.

If you want to cancel it, select “Cancel”.

— Manage phone

Page 372: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

372

3. When the connection is completed,this screen is displayed.You do not need to enter the phone in caseof using the same one.

When this screen is displayed, follow theguidance on the screen to try again.

When another Bluetooth� device isconnected

When another Bluetooth� device is cur-rently connected, this screen is displayed.

If you want to disconnect it, select “Yes”.

INFORMATIONWhen you register your phone,Bluetooth� audio will disconnect. Itwill reconnect automatically whenyou finish registration. It will not bereconnected depending on the phoneyou are using.

Page 373: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

373

You can also register a new Bluetooth�phone in the following way.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Manage Phone”.

4. Select “Options”.

5. Select “New Phone”.

6. Select “(empty)” to register yourcellular phone to the system.The following operations are the sameas the operation after you select “(addnew)”.

Page 374: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

374

� Selecting a Bluetooth� phoneIn case you register more than oneBluetooth� phone, you need to choosewhich phone to connect to.You can select from up to 4 registeredBluetooth� phones.“(add new)” is displayed when you havenot registered a Bluetooth� phone yet.

Although you can register up to 4Bluetooth� phones in the system, only oneBluetooth� phone can function at a time.

1. Select the phone to connect.The Bluetooth� mark is displayed whenyou connect the phone.

2. The “Connect Bluetooth*” screen isdisplayed.

3. When the result message is dis-played, you can use the Bluetooth�phone.*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

Page 375: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

375

When you connect the phone whileBluetooth� audio is playing

This screen is displayed, and theBluetooth� audio will stop temporarily.

When another Bluetooth� device isconnected

When another Bluetooth� device is cur-rently connected, this screen is displayed.

If you want to disconnect it, select “Yes”.

Setting the handsfree powerYou can select the state of “HandsfreePower”.

The state changes between “On” and“Off” every time you select “HandsfreePower”.For the “Handsfree Power”, see“Changing the handsfree power” onpage 401.

Page 376: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

376

� Editing the Bluetooth� phoneYou can see the information of theBluetooth� phone on the system oredit.“Device Name”

The name of the Bluetooth�. . . . . phone which is displayed onthe screen. You can change itto a desired name.

If you change the devicename, the name registered inyour cellular phone is notchanged.

“Device Address”The device address is unique. . . . . to each phone. You cannotchange it.

If you have two registeredBluetooth� phones with thesame device name, you can-not distinguish one from theother without referring to thedevice address.

1. Select “Options”.

2. Select “Edit Phones”.

3. Select the phone to edit.

4. This screen is displayed.If you want to change the device name,select “Edit”.

Page 377: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

377

5. Use the software keyboard to inputthe device name.

6. Confirm the device name and select“OK”.

� Deleting a Bluetooth� phone

1. Select “Options”.

2. Select “Remove Phones”.

Page 378: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

378

3. Select the desired phone or select“Select All”, then select “Delete”.You can select multiple phones and deletethem at the same time.

4. Select “Yes”.

INFORMATIONWhen you delete a Bluetooth�phone, the phonebook data will bedeleted at the same time.

� By voice recognition

You can operate “Connect Phone” by giv-ing a command.

“Connect Phone” includes “Select Phone”,“Add New Phone” and “Handsfree PowerOff” (On).

The operating procedure is similar to othervoice recognition. (For the operation ofvoice recognition, see “Voice commandsystem” on page 50.)

When you select the command of “AddNew Phone”, you must carry out the follow-ing operation on the screen.

Page 379: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

379

INFORMATIONPhonebook data is managed inde-pendently for every registeredphone. When another phone is con-nected, you cannot read anotherphone’s registered data.

“Phonebook” is accessed from the“Phonebook Settings” screen.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Setup”.3. Select “Phone”.

4. Select “Phonebook”.

Please do each setting from thisscreen.

“Setting the phonebook” is accessedfrom the “Contacts” screen.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Setup”.3. Select “Phone”.4. Select “Phonebook”.

5. Select “Manage Contacts”.

Please refer to the following pages foreach setting.

— Phonebook — Setting the phonebook

Page 380: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

380

You can also display the “Contacts”screen in the following way.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Contacts”.

4. Select “Options”.

5. Select “Manage Contacts”.

� Transferring a phone numberYou can transfer the phone numbers inyour Bluetooth� phone to the system.The phonebook manages a maximumof 4 phonebooks in all. Data for up to1000 people (up to 3 numbers per per-son) can be registered in eachphonebook.Transfer contacts while the hybrid systemis operating <the engine is running>.

1. Select “Transfer Contacts”.

2. Select “Replace Contacts” or “AddContacts”.In case that the phonebook containsphonebook data, this screen is displayed.

Page 381: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

381

3. Transfer the phonebook data to thesystem using the Bluetooth� phone.This screen appears while transferring. Tocancel it, select “Cancel”. If the transfer-ring is interrupted on the way, the phone-book data transferred until then can bememorized in the system.

When you have selected “Replace Con-tacts”:If your cellular phone does not supportPBAP or OPP profiles, you cannot use thisfunction.

If your phone supports PBAP profile, youcan transfer the phonebook data withoutoperating your phone.

If your phone does not support PBAP pro-file, you must transfer the phonebook databy operating your phone.

When you have selected “Add Con-tacts”:If your cellular phone does not support theBluetooth� OPP profile, you cannot usethis function.

If your cellular phone supports OPP pro-file, you can transfer the phonebook databy operating your phone.

4. In case that you have selected “AddContacts”, this screen is displayed.If you want to transfer another phone-book, select “Yes”.

Page 382: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

382

When another Bluetooth� device isconnected

When another Bluetooth� device is cur-rently connected, this screen is displayed.

If you want to disconnect it, select “Yes”.

INFORMATIONBluetooth� audio will disconnectduring transfer on phonebook data.In this case, it will reconnect auto-matically when data transfer finish-es. (It will not be reconnected de-pending the phone you are using.)

� Registering the phonebook dataYou can register the phonebook data.Up to 3 numbers per person can be reg-istered.

1. Select “New Contact”.

2. Use the software keyboard to inputthe name and select “OK”.

Page 383: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

383

3. Input the phone number and select“OK”.If you want to use the tone signal afterthe phone number, input the tone signaltoo.

4. Select the phone type.

5. When two or less numbers in totalare registered to this contact, thisscreen is displayed.When you want to add a number to thiscontact, select “Yes”.

Page 384: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

384

� Editing the phonebook dataYou can register the phone number in“Phone#1”, “Phone#2” and “Phone#3”separately.

1. Select “Edit Contacts”.

2. Select the data you want to edit.

3. Select “Edit” for the desired nameor number.4. Edit the name or the number. (See “�Registering the phonebook data” onpage 382.)5. When you complete the edit, select“Save”.

Page 385: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

385

You can also display the “Edit Contact”screen in the following ways.

From “Contact Data” screen1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Contacts”.4. Select the desired data from the list.

5. Select “Options”.

6. Select “Edit Contact”.

From “Call History” screen1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Call History”.4. Select the desired number from thelist.

5. Select “Add Contact” or “UpdateContact”.

6. In case that you have selected “Up-date Contact”, this screen is displayed.Select the desired data from the list.

Page 386: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

386

� Deleting the phonebook dataYou can delete the data.When you release your car, delete allyour data on the system.

1. Select “Delete Contacts”.

2. Select the desired data or select“Select All”, then select “Delete”.You can select multiple data and deletethem at the same time.

3. Select “Yes”.

Page 387: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

387

You can also delete it in the followingway.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Contacts”.4. Select the desired data from the list.

5. Select “Options”.

6. Select “Delete Contact”.

7. Select “Yes”.

INFORMATIONWhen you delete a Bluetooth�phone, the phonebook data will bedeleted at the same time.

Page 388: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

388

“Speed dials setting” is accessed fromthe “Speed Dials” screen.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Setup”.3. Select “Phone”.4. Select “Phonebook”.

5. Select “Manage Speed Dials”.

Please refer to the following pages foreach setting.

You can also display the “Speed Dials”screen in the following way.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Speed Dials”.

4. Select “Options”.

— Speed dials setting

Page 389: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

389

� Registering the speed dialYou can register the desired phonenumber from phonebook. Up to 18numbers per phone can be registered.

1. Select “New Speed Dial”.

2. Select the data you want to register.

3. Select the desired phone number.

4. Select the button you want to regis-ter in.

Page 390: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

390

5. If you select a button you registeredbefore, this screen is displayed.Select “Yes” if you want to replace it.

6. When this screen is displayed, theoperation is complete.

You can also register the speed dial inthe following ways.From “Speed Dial” screen1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Speed Dials”.

4. Select “(add new)”.

5. Select “Yes” to set new speed dial.

Page 391: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

391

6. Select the data you want to register.

7. Select the desired phone number.

From “Contact Data” screen1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Contacts”.4. Select the desired data from the list.

5. Select “Options”.

6. Select “Set Speed Dial”.

Page 392: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

392

7. This screen is displayed.The following operations are the sameas the operation when you operate itfrom “Setup” screen.

� Editing the speed dialYou can edit the speed dial.

1. Select “Edit Speed Dials”.

2. Select the button you want to edit.

3. Select “Edit”.

Page 393: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

393

4. Use the software keyboard to inputthe name.

5. Select “Save”.

� Deleting the speed dialYou can delete the speed dial.

1. Select “Delete Speed Dials”.

2. Select the desired data or select“Select All”, then select “Delete”.You can select multiple data and deletethem at the same time.

Page 394: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

394

3. Select “Yes”.

You can delete the call history.

1. Select “Delete Call History”.

2. Select the desired history to delete.

— Deleting call history

Page 395: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

395

3. Select the desired data or select“Select All”, then select “Delete”.You can select multiple data and deletethem at the same time.

4. Select “Yes”.

You can also delete the call history inthe following way.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Call History”.

4. Select “Delete”.

5. This screen is displayed.The following operations are the sameas the operation when you operate itfrom “Setup” screen.You can similarly operate other call his-tory.

Page 396: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

396

“Setting the voice tag” is done by dis-playing “Voice Tags” screen.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Setup”.3. Select “Phone”.4. Select “Phonebook”.

5. Select “Manage Voice Tags”.

Please refer to the following pages foreach setting.When recording a voice tag, do so in aquiet area.

You can also display “Voice Tags”screen in the following way.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Contacts”.

4. Select “Options”.

5. Select “Manage Voice Tags”.

— Setting the voice tag

Page 397: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

397

� Registering the voice tagYou can register a voice tag for up to 20numbers.

1. Select “New Voice Tag”.

2. Select the data you want to register.

3. Select “� REC”, and record a voicetag.

4. Select “� Play” to play the voicetag.When you complete the voice tag registra-tion, select “OK”.

INFORMATIONWhen you use the voice tag, do notchange the language setting fromthe language setting used when reg-istering.If they are different, the voice recog-nition can’t recognize the voice tagthat you have registered.

Page 398: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

398

You can also register the voice tag inthe following way.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Info./Phone”.2. Select “Phone”.3. Select “Contacts”.4. Select the desired data from the list.

5. Select “Options”.

6. Select “Set Voice Tag”.

7. This screen is displayed.The following operations are the sameas the operation when you operate itfrom “Setup” screen.

Page 399: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

399

� Editing the voice tag

1. Select “Edit Voice Tags”.

2. Select the data you want to edit.

3. This screen is displayed.The following operations are the sameas the operation when you register thevoice tag.

� Deleting the voice tag

1. Select “Delete Voice Tags”.

2. Select the desired data or select“Select All”, then select “Delete”.You can select multiple data and deletethem at the same time.

3. Select “Yes”.

Page 400: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

400

You can confirm and change theBluetooth� settings.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Setup”.3. Select “Phone”.

4. Select “Bluetooth*”.

5. This screen is displayed.

*: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG, Inc.

The information displays the followingitems.

“Device Name”This name will be displayed on. . . . . the phone when registering anew device. You can changeit.

“Passcode”The password when you regis-. . . . . ter your Bluetooth� phone inthe system. You can change it.

“Device Address”This address is unique to the. . . . . system. You cannot change it.If the same device name isdisplayed on the screen ofyour phone, refer to it.

If you want to change the settings, referto the following pages.When you change the settings, select“Save” after changing them.

— Bluetooth�

Page 401: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

401

� Changing the Bluetooth� settingsYou can change the Bluetooth� set-tings according to the following proce-dures.

Changing the handsfree powerThe “Handsfree Power” display showsthe following state.When “Handsfree Power” is “On”:

The Bluetooth� phone is automaticallyconnected when the “POWER” <“ENGINESTART STOP”> switch is in ACCESSORYor ON <IGNITION ON> mode.

When “Handsfree Power” is “Off”:The Bluetooth� phone is disconnected,and the system will not connect to it nexttime.

You can select the state of “HandsfreePower”.On: The auto connection is turned on.Off: The auto connection is turned off.You can not change the state from “On”into “Off” while driving.

1. Select “Handsfree Power”.

2. Select “On” or “Off”.

Page 402: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

402

3. Select “Save”.In case that the state of “HandsfreePower” is changed from “Off” into“On”, Bluetooth� connection will be-gin.When you connect the phone whileBluetooth� audio is playing

This screen is displayed, and theBluetooth� audio will stop temporarily.

Editing the device name

1. Select “Edit” of “Device Name”.

2. Use the software keyboard to inputthe device name.

INFORMATIONThe device names are commonbetween Bluetooth� audio andBluetooth� phone.If you change the device name of thephone, the device name of the audiowill change at same time.However, passcodes can be set sep-arately.

Page 403: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

403

Editing the passcode

1. Select “Edit” of “Passcode”.

2. Input a passcode and select “OK”.

� Initializing the Bluetooth� settingsYou can initialize the settings.

1. Select “Default”.

2. Select “Yes”.If the state of “Handsfree Power” ischanged from “Off” into “On”, Bluetooth�connection will begin.

Page 404: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

404

If you connect a phone whileBluetooth� audio is playing

This screen is displayed, and theBluetooth� audio will stop temporarily.

You can do the detail settings.1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Setup”.3. Select “Phone”.

4. Select “Details”.

5. Do each setting according to the fol-lowing procedures.6. When you complete each setting,select “Save”.

— Details

Page 405: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

405

� Incoming call display

You can select the method of the in-coming call display.

1. Select “Incoming Call DisplayMode”.

2. Select “Full Screen” or “DropDown”.“Full Screen” mode

When a call is received, the. . . . . Hands−free screen is dis-played and you can operate iton the screen.

“Drop Down” modeThe message is displayed on. . . . . the upper side of the screen.You can only operate thesteering switch.

Page 406: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

406

� The Bluetooth� connection statusat start up

When the “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is in ACCESSORY orON <IGNITION ON> mode and the Blue-tooth� is automatically connected, theconnection check is displayed.When “Display Phone Status” is “On”,this status is displayed.When “Display Phone Status” is “Off”,this status is not displayed.

1. Select “Display Phone Status”.

2. Select “On” or “Off”.

Page 407: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

407

� Initializing the settingsYou can initialize the settings.

1. Select “Default”.

2. Select “Yes”.

The portable player to connect can beselected. The registered audio informa-tion can be confirmed and edited.� Selecting a portable playerIf you register a second portable player,either one can be selected for connec-tion.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U4001LS

2. Select “Setup”.

U10005LS

3. Select “Audio” on “Setup” screen.

Audio settings —— Select portable player

Page 408: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

408

4. Select “Select Portable Player” on“Audio Settings” screen.You can select from a maximum of twoBluetooth� portable players.

“Empty” is displayed when you have notregistered a portable player yet. TheBluetooth� mark is displayed when youchoose the portable player.

5. Select desired portable player andthen select “OK”.Although you can register up to two porta-ble players in the system, only one porta-ble player can function at a time.

� Displaying Bluetooth� informationYou can see or change the informationof the portable player on the system.“Device Name”

The name of Bluetooth� portable. . . player which is displayed on thescreen. You can change it into a de-sired name.

“Device Address”This address is unique to the system.. . . You cannot change it. If you have reg-istered two Bluetooth� portable play-ers with the same device name andyou cannot distinguish one from theother, refer to it.

“Connection Method”The connection method can be. . . switched between “From Vehicle” and“From Portable Player”.

Select the desired portable player andthen select “Portable Player Info”.

Page 409: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

409

� Changing a device nameYou can change a device name. Even ifyou change a device name, the nameregistered in your portable player is notchanged.

1. Select “Portable Player Info” on“Select Portable Player” screen.

2. Select “Edit” for “Device Name” on“Portable Player Information” screen.

3. Use the software keyboard to inputthe device name.

� Selecting Connection methodThe connection method can be se-lected.From Vehicle: Connect the audio sys-tem to the portable player.From Portable Player: Connect the por-table player to the audio system.

Select desired connection method“From Vehicle” or “From PortablePlayer” and then select “Save”.

INFORMATIONIf the connection method is set to“From Portable Player”, “AutoBluetooth∗ Connect” cannot beselected.

∗: Bluetooth is a registered trademark ofBluetooth SIG.Inc.

Page 410: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

410

The Bluetooth� audio settings can beset.� Registering your portable player

1. Select “Bluetooth∗ Audio Setting”on “Audio Settings” screen.

2. Select “Register” of “Bluetooth∗

Audio” on “BT Audio Settings” screen.∗: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of

Bluetooth SIG.Inc.

3. When this screen is displayed, enterthe passcode displayed on the screeninto the portable player.For the operation of the portable player,see the manual that comes with it.

If you want to cancel the entry, select “Can-cel”.

4. When the connection is complete,this screen is displayed.You do not need to enter the portable play-er in case of using the same one.

When this screen is displayed, follow theguidance on the screen to try connectionagain.

— Setting Bluetooth� audio

Page 411: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

411

When another Bluetooth� device isconnectedIf you want to disconnect it, select “Yes”.

INFORMATIONIf the device corresponds with bothBluetooth� phone and Bluetooth�audio, register and connect theBluetooth� phone first or aconnection failure may occur whenregistering the Bluetooth� audio.

(a) Removing a Bluetooth� audio

1. Select “Remove” of “Bluetooth∗

Audio” on “BT Audio Settings” screen.

2. Select the portable player you wantto delete and select “OK”.

3. Select “Yes” to unregister the se-lected portable player.∗: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of

Bluetooth SIG.Inc.

Page 412: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

412

If the selected portable player is in use, thisscreen will appear. Select “Yes”. The sys-tem will disconnect the portable player andremove it.

(b) Connecting Bluetooth� audioAUTOMATICALLY

Select “On” for “Auto Bluetooth∗ Connect”to activate the automatic connection forthe Bluetooth�. Always set it to this modeand leave the Bluetooth� portable player ina condition where connection can beestablished. The “Auto Bluetooth∗

Connect” cannot be selected if theconnection method is set to “FromPortable Player”.∗: Bluetooth is a registered trademark of

Bluetooth SIG.Inc.

Page 413: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

413

When the “POWER” <“ENGINE STARTSTOP”> switch is in ACCESSORY or ON<IGNITION ON> mode, the selected por-table player will be automatically con-nected and the connection result is dis-played.

MANUALLYWhen the auto connection failed or turnedoff, you have to connect Bluetooth� manu-ally.

For the manual operation, see page 259.

(c) Changing the passcodeThe passcode for registering your por-table player on the system. You canchange this to 4 to 8 digit number ofyour choice. The default is “0000”.

1. Select “Edit” of “Passcode” on “BTAudio Settings” screen.

2. Enter the new 4−8 digits passcodeand select “OK”.

Each time you select , an input digit

is deleted.

Page 414: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

414

(d) Changing the device nameYou can change a device name. Even ifyou change a device name, the nameregistered on your portable player isnot changed.

1. Select “Edit” of “Device Name” on“BT Audio Settings” screen.

2. Enter the new device name and se-lect “OK”.

INFORMATIONThe device names are commonbetween Bluetooth� audio andBluetooth� phone.If you change the device name of theaudio, the device name of the phonewill change at same time.However, passcodes can be setseparately.

(e) Initializing the Bluetooth� audiosettingsYou can initialize the settings.

1. Select “Default” on “BT Audio Set-tings” screen.

2. Select “Yes”.

Page 415: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

415

When the navigation system is turned on,the “Information” screen displays when it istime to replace a part or certain compo-nents. (See page 31.)

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U4001LS

2. Select “Setup”.

U10006LS

3. Select “Vehicle”.

4. Select “Maintenance”.

� Setting maintenance information (Seepage 416.)

� Setting dealer (See page 417.)

Vehicle settings —— Maintenance

Page 416: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

416

(a) Maintenance information setting1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Maintenance” on the “Ve-hicle Settings” screen.

4. Select the desired button.For details of each button, see “INFORMA-TION ITEMS” on page 416.

“Delete All”: To cancel all conditionswhich have been inputted.

“Reset All”: To reset the item which hassatisfied a condition.

“Set Dealer”: To register dealer informa-tion. (See “ (b) Dealer setting” on page417.)

“Dealer Info.”: To edit dealer information.(See “ (b) Dealer setting” on page 417.)

“Reminder”: When this button is se-lected, the indicator is illuminated. Thesystem is set to give maintenance informa-tion with the “Information” screen. (Seepage 31.)

When the vehicle needs to be serviced, thebutton color will change to orange.

INFORMATION ITEMS“Engine oil”: Replace engine oil

“Oil filter”: Replace engine oil filter

“Rotation”: Rotate tires

“Tires”: Replace tires

“Battery”: Replace 12−volt battery

“Brake pad”: Replace brake linings

“Wipers”: Replace wiper blades

“Coolant”: Replace engine coolant

“Brake oil”: Replace brake fluid

“Trans. fluid”: Replace transmission fluid

“Service”: Scheduled maintenance

“Air filter”: Replace air filter

“Personal”: New information items canbe created separately from provided ones.

Page 417: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

417

5. Input the conditions.“Date”: The next maintenance date can beinput.

“Distance”: The driving distance until thenext maintenance check can be input.

“Delete”: To cancel the date and distanceconditions.

“Reset”: To reset the date and distanceconditions.6. Select “OK”.The screen then returns to the “Mainte-nance” screen.

INFORMATION� For scheduled maintenance infor-

mation, please refer to the “War-ranty and Services Guide/Owner’sManual Supplement/ScheduledMaintenance”.

� Depending on driving or road con-ditions, the actual date and dis-tance may differ from the storeddate and distance in the system.

(b) Dealer settingIt is possible to register a dealer in the sys-tem. With dealer information registered,route guidance to the dealer is available.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “Maintenance” on the “Ve-hicle Settings” screen.

4. Select “Set Dealer”.

5. If the dealer has not been registered,enter the location of the dealer in thesame way as for a destination search.(See “Destination search” on page 68.)

When “Set Dealer” registration is finished,the “Dealer” screen will be displayed.

Page 418: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

418

6. Select “Edit” for the item you wantto change.“Dealer”: To enter the name of a dealer.(See page 418.)

“Contact”: To enter the name of a dealermember. (See page 418.)

“Location”: To set a location. (See page419.)

“Phone #”: To set a telephone number.(See page 419.)

“Delete Dealer”: To delete the dealer in-formation displayed on the screen.

“Enter ”: To set the displayed dealer asa destination. (See “Starting route guid-ance” on page 89.)

� To edit “Dealer” or “Contact”

1. Select “Edit” of “Dealer” or “Con-tact”.

2. Enter the name using the alphanu-meric keys.Up to 32 characters can be entered.

3. Select “OK”.The previous screen will be displayed.

Page 419: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

419

� To edit “Location”

1. Select “Edit” of “Location”.

2. Select the 8 directional button tomove the cursor to the desired pointon the map.3. Select “OK”.The previous screen will be displayed.

� To edit “Phone #” (telephone num-ber)

1. Select “Edit” of “Phone #”.

2. Enter the number using numberkeys.3. Select “OK”.The previous screen will be displayed.

Page 420: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

420

Vehicle settings can be changed.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Setup” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup”screen.

4. Select “Vehicle Customization”

5. Select the setting to be changed.Various settings can be changed. For alist of the settings that can be changed,see the vehicle owner’s manual.6. After changing the settings, select“Save”. A message indicating that thesettings are being saved will appear.Do not perform any other operationswhile this message is displayed.

CAUTION

When performing the customizationprocedure, ensure that there is suffi-cient ventilation in the vehicle andsurrounding area. If there is insuffi-cient ventilation, exhaust gases maycollect and enter the vehicle. Ex-haust gases include harmful carbonmonoxide (CO) and inhaling themmay lead to death or a serious healthhazard.

INFORMATIONStop the vehicle in a safe place, setthe parking brake and put the shift le-ver in “P”. To avoid discharging the12−volt battery, perform thecustomization procedure with the hy-brid system operating <the enginerunning>.

— Vehicle customization

Page 421: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

421

The volume of the beeps and turning on oroff of the display can be set.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch. (See “— Remote Touch”on page 10.)2. Select “Setup” on the “Start”screen.3. Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup”screen.

4. Select “LEXUS Park Assist”.

5. Select the desired button.6. Select “Save”.

� Setting an alert volumeThe alert volume can be adjusted.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “LEXUS Park Assist” on the“Vehicle Settings” screen.

4. Select the desired button.The volume has 5 levels, increasing withhigher value.

5. Select “Save”.

— Intuitive parking assistsetting

Page 422: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

422

� Setting a parking sonar display“On” or “Off” can be selected for parkingsonar display.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “LEXUS Park Assist” on the“Vehicle Settings” screen.

4. Select the desired button.5. Select “Save”.Vehicles with parking assist monitor—

Although “Off” is selected, if the obstacleis detected during the intuitive parking as-sist monitoring, the warning appears onthe right top of the screen.

� Setting a display and tone indica-tion

Back sensors display and tone indicationcan be set.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch, then select “Setup”.2. Select “Vehicle” on the “Setup”screen.3. Select “LEXUS Park Assist” on the“Vehicle Settings” screen.

4. Select “Rear”.Selecting “Rear” to switch the distance forthe back sensors display and tone indica-tion, from long distance to short distance,or from short distance to long distance.

5. Select “Save”.

Page 423: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

423

Used for changing settings for Lexus Insid-er and XM� Sports and Stocks.

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

2. Select “Setup”.

U10007LS

3. Select “Other”.

On this screen, the following functions canbe performed.

No. Function

1 Sets Lexus Insider(See page 182.)

2 Sets XM sports(See page 171.)

3 Sets XM stocks(See page 173.)

Other settings

Page 424: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SETUP

424

Page 425: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

SECTION 13

APPENDIX

425

APPENDIX

� Limitations of the navigation system 426. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

� Map database information and updates 428. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

13

Page 426: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

426

This navigation system calculates thecurrent vehicle position using satellitesignals, various vehicle signals, mapdata, etc. However, the accurate posi-tion may not be shown depending onthe satellite condition, road configura-tion, vehicle condition or other circum-stances.The Global Positioning System (GPS) de-veloped and operated by the U.S. Depart-ment of Defense provides an accurate cur-rent vehicle position, normally using 4 ormore satellites, and in some case 3 satel-lites. The GPS system has a certain levelof inaccuracy. While the navigation sys-tem will compensate for this most of thetime, occasional positioning errors of up to300 feet (100 m) can and should be expec-ted. Generally, position errors will be cor-rected within a few seconds.

When your vehicle is receiving signalsfrom the satellites, the “GPS” mark ap-pears at the top left of the screen.

The GPS signal may be physically ob-structed, leading to inaccurate vehicleposition on the map display. Tunnels, tallbuildings, trucks, or even the placement ofobjects on the instrument panel may ob-struct the GPS signals.

The GPS satellites may not send signalsdue to repairs or improvements beingmade to them.

Even when the navigation system is re-ceiving clear GPS signals, the vehicleposition may not be shown accurately orinappropriate route guidance may occur insome cases.

NOTICE

The installation of window tintingmay obstruct the GPS signals. Mostwindow tinting contains some metal-lic content that will interfere with GPSsignal reception of the antenna in theinstrument panel. We advise againstthe use of window tinting on vehiclesequipped with navigation systems.

Limitations of the navigation system

Page 427: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

427

(a) Accurate current vehicle positionmay not be shown in the followingcases:� When driving on a small angled Y−

shaped road.

� When driving on a winding road.

� When driving on a slippery road suchas in sand, gravel, snow, etc.

� When driving on a long straight road.

� When motorway and surface streetsrun in parallel.

� After moving by ferry or vehicle carrier.

� When a long route is searched duringhigh speed driving.

� When driving without setting the cur-rent position calibration correctly.

� After repeating a change of direction bygoing forward and backward, or turningon a turntable in the parking lot.

� When leaving a covered parking lot orparking garage.

� When a roof carrier is installed.

� When driving with tire chains installed.

� When the tires are worn.

� After replacing a tire or tires.

� When using tires that are smaller orlarger than the factory specifications.

� When the tire pressure in any of thefour tires is not correct.

INFORMATIONIf your vehicle cannot receive GPSsignals, you can correct the currentposition manually. For informationon setting the current position cal-ibration, see page 365.

(b) Inappropriate route guidance mayoccur in the following cases:� When turning at an intersection off the

designated route guidance.

� If you set more than one destination butskip any of them, auto reroute will dis-play a route returning to the destinationon the previous route.

� When turning at an intersection forwhich there is no route guidance.

� When passing through an intersectionfor which there is no route guidance.

� During auto reroute, the route guid-ance may not be available for the nextturn to the right or left.

� It may take a long time to operate autoreroute during high speed driving. Inauto reroute, a detour route may beshown.

� After auto reroute, the route may not bechanged.

� An unnecessary U−turn may be shownor announced.

� A location may have multiple namesand the system will announce one ormore.

� Some routes may not be searched.

� If the route to your destination includesgravel, unpaved roads or alleys, theroute guidance may not be shown.

� Your destination point might be shownon the opposite side of the street.

� When a portion of the route has regula-tions prohibiting the entry of the vehiclethat vary by time or season or otherreasons.

� The road and map data stored in yournavigation system may not be com-plete or may not be the latest version.

13

Page 428: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

428

After replacing a tire, implement the op-eration described in the “TIRECHANGE CALIBRATION”. (See page367.)This navigation system uses tire turningdata and is designed to work with factory−specified tires for your vehicle. Installingtires that are larger or smaller than the orig-inally equipped diameter may cause inac-curate display of the vehicle’s position.The tire pressure also affects the diameterof the tires so please make sure the tirepressure of all four tires is correct.

This system uses the maps of DENSO.

© 2010 DENSO CORPORATION

© 2009 NAVTEQ. All rights reserved.

© 2010 Tele Atlas North America, Inc.All rights reserved. This material is pro-prietary and the subject of copyrightprotection and other intellectual prop-erty rights owned by or licensed to TeleAtlas North America, Inc. The use ofthis material is subject to the terms ofa license agreement. You will be heldliable for any unauthorized copying ordisclosure of this material.

Data by infoUSA Copyright © 2009, AllRights Reserved.

© 2009 VISA Corporation

Copyright © CoStar Realty InformationInc.

The Bullseye Design is a registeredtrademark of Target Brands, Inc.

The building footprints and related car-tographic information in this productcomes with MAPMASTER digital ma-terials.

Map database informationand updates

Page 429: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

429

END USER LICENSE AGREEMENTPLEASE READ THIS AGREEMENTCAREFULLY BEFORE USING THE

NAVIGATION SYSTEM

THIS IS A LICENSE AGREEMENTFOR YOUR COPY OF THE SPATIALMAP DATABASE, INCLUDING LOCA-TION CODES AND RELATED PROD-UCTS (COLLECTIVELY, THE “DATA-BASE”), USED IN THE NAVIGATIONSYSTEM. BY USING THE NAVIGA-TION SYSTEM AND THE DATA-BASE, YOU ACCEPT AND AGREETO BE BOUND BY ALL TERMS ANDCONDITIONS SET FORTH BELOW.

LICENSE GRANTDENSO CORPORATION (“DENSO”),as a licensed distributor of theDATABASE, grants to you anon−exclusive, non−perpetual licenseto use your copy of the DATABASE foryour personal use or for your use inyour business’ internal operations andnot for any other purpose. This licensedoes not include the right to grantsub−licenses.

OWNERSHIPThe DATABASE and the copyrightsand intellectual property andneighboring rights therein are ownedby Tele Atlas North America, Inc.(“TANA”) and its licensors. ThisAgreement does not transfer any titleor interest in the DATABASE, exceptfor the license to use the DATABASEaccording and subject to the terms andconditions of this Agreement. Youshall not alter, obscure or remove anycopyright notices, trademark notices orother restrictive legends relating to theDATABASE.

The DATABASE comprises confiden-tial and proprietary information andmaterials of TANA. Accordingly, youshall hold the DATABASE in confi-dence and trust. You shall take rea-sonable steps to protect the DATA-BASE from misappropriation or mis-use. You shall not extract stand−alonedata from or publish any part of the DA-TABASE without the prior written con-sent of TANA and its licensors.

LIMITATIONS ON USEThe DATABASE is restricted for use inthe specific system for which it wascreated. Except to the extent explicitlypermitted by mandatory laws, you maynot extract or reutilize any portion ofthe contents of the DATABASE, norreproduce, copy, duplicate, modify,adapt, translate, disassemble,decompile, or reverse engineer anyportion of the DATABASE.

TRANSFERYou may not transfer the DATABASEto third parties, except together withthe system for which it was created,provided that you do not retain anycopy of the DATABASE, and providedthat the transferee agrees to all termsand conditions of this AGREEMENT.

13

Page 430: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

430

DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTYTHE DATABASE IS PROVIDED ONAN “AS IS” AND “WITH ALL FAULTSBASIS” AND DENSO AND TANA(AND THEIR LICENSORS AND SUP-PLIERS) EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMALL OTHER WARRANTIES, EX-PRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDINGBUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIEDWARRANTIES OF NON−INFRINGE-MENT, MERCHANTABILITY, SAT-ISFACTORY QUALITY, ACCURACY,TITLE AND FITNESS FOR A PARTIC-ULAR PURPOSE. NO ORAL ORWRITTEN ADVICE OR INFORMA-TION PROVIDED BY DENSO ORTANA (OR ANY OF THEIR LICEN-SORS, AGENTS, EMPLOYEES ORTHIRD PARTY PROVIDERS) SHALLCREATE A WARRANTY, AND YOUARE NOT ENTITLED TO RELY ONANY SUCH ADVICE OR INFORMA-TION. THIS DISCLAIMER OF WAR-RANTIES IS AN ESSENTIAL CON-DITION OF THIS AGREEMENT.

LIMITATION OF LIABILITYIN NO EVENT SHALL DENSO ORTANA (OR THEIR LICENSORS ORSUPPLIERS) BE LIABLE FOR ANYINCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL,SPECIAL, INDIRECT OREXEMPLARY DAMAGES ARISINGOUT OF THIS AGREEMENT ORYOUR USE OF THE DATABASE,INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION,LOST PROFITS OR COSTS OFCOVER, LOSS OF USE ORBUSINESS INTERRUPTION OR THELIKE, REGARDLESS OF WHETHERTHE PARTY WAS ADVISED OF THEPOSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.

IN NO EVENT WILL THE TOTALLIABILITY OF DENSO OR TANA (ORTHEIR LICENSORS ORSUPPLIERS) EXCEED THEAMOUNTS PAID BY YOU FOR THEDATABASE.

WARNINGSThe DATABASE comprises facts andinformation from government andother sources reflectingcircumstances in existence before youreceived the DATABASE, which maycontain errors and omissions.Accordingly, the DATABASE maycontain inaccurate or incompleteinformation due to the passage of time,changing circumstances, and due tothe nature of the sources used. TheDATABASE does not include or reflectinformation relating to, among otherthings, neighborhood safety; lawenforcement; emergency assistance;construction work; road or laneclosures; vehicle or speed restrictions;road slope or grade; bridge height,weight or other limits; road or trafficconditions; special events; trafficcongestion; or travel time.

Page 431: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

431

U.S. GOVERNMENT RIGHTSIf you are an agency, department, orother entity of the United StatesGovernment, or funded in whole or inpart by the United States Government,then use, duplication, reproduction,release, modification, disclosure ortransfer of this commercial product andaccompanying documentation, isrestricted in accordance with theLIMITED or RESTRICTED rights asdescribed in DFARS252.227−7014(a)(1) (JUN 1995)(DOD commercial computer softwaredefinition), DFARS 227.7202−1 (DODpolicy on commercial computersoftware), FAR 52.227−19 (JUN 1987)(commercial computer softwareclause for civilian agencies), DFARS252.227−7015 (NOV 1995) (DODtechnical data − commercial itemsclause); FAR 52.227−14 Alternates I,II, and III (JUN 1987) (civilian agencytechnical data and noncommercialcomputer software clause); and/orFAR 12.211 and FAR 12.212(commercial item acquisitions), asapplicable. In case of conflict betweenany of the FAR and DFARS provisionslisted herein and this Agreement, theconstruction that provides greaterlimitations on the Government’s rightsshall control.

Contractor/manufacturer is Tele AtlasNorth America, Inc., 11 LafayetteStreet, Lebanon, NH 03766−1445.Phone: 603.643.0330. The DATA-BASE is ©1984−2010 by Tele AtlasNorth America, Inc. ALL RIGHTS RE-SERVED. For purpose of any publicdisclosure provision under any federal,state or local law, it is agreed that theDATABASE is a trade secret and a pro-prietary commercial product and notsubject to disclosure.

If you are an agency, department, orother entity of any State government,the United States Government or anyother public entity or funded in whole orin part by the United States Govern-ment, then you hereby agree to protectthe DATABASE from public disclosureand to consider the DATABASE ex-empt from any statute, law, regulation,or code, including any Sunshine Act,Public Records Act, Freedom of Infor-mation Act, or equivalent, which per-mits public access and/or reproductionor use of the Licensed Products. In theevent that such exemption is chal-lenged under any such laws, thisAgreement shall be consideredbreached and any and all right to retainany copies or to use of the DATABASEshall be terminated and considered im-mediately null and void. Any copies ofthe DATABASE held by you shall im-mediately be destroyed. If any court ofcompetent jurisdiction considers thisclause void and unenforceable, inwhole or in part, for any reason, thisAgreement shall be considered termi-nated and null and void, in its entirety,and any and all copies of the DATA-BASE shall immediately be destroyed.

13

Page 432: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

432

END USER TERMSThe data (“Data”) is provided for yourpersonal, internal use only and not forresale. It is protected by copyright, andis subject to the following terms andconditions which are agreed to by you,on the one hand, and DENSO COR-PORATION (“DENSO”) and its licen-sors (including their licensors and sup-pliers) on the other hand.

© 2009 NAVTEQ. All rights reserved.

NAVTEQ holds a non−exclusive li-cense from the United States PostalService� to publish and sell ZIP+4�information.

©United States Postal Service�2009.Prices are not established, controlledor approved by the United States Post-al Service�. The following trademarksand registrations are owned by theUSPS: United States Postal Service,USPS, and ZIP+4.

TERMS AND CONDITIONS

Personal Use Only. You agree to usethis Data together with vehicle naviga-tion system for the solely personal,non−commercial purposes for whichyou were licensed, and not for servicebureau, time−sharing or other similarpurposes. Accordingly, but subject tothe restrictions set forth in the followingparagraphs, you may copy this Dataonly as necessary for your personaluse to (i) view it, and (ii) save it, pro-vided that you do not remove any copy-right notices that appear and do notmodify the Data in any way. You agreenot to otherwise reproduce, copy,modify, decompile, disassemble or re-verse engineer any portion of thisData, and may not transfer or distributeit in any form, for any purpose, exceptto the extent permitted by mandatorylaws. Multi−disc sets may only betransferred or sold as a complete setas provided by DENSO and not as asubset thereof.

Page 433: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

433

Restrictions. Except where you havebeen specifically licensed to do so byDENSO, and without limiting the pre-ceding paragraph, you may not (a) usethis Data with any products, systems,or applications installed or otherwiseconnected to or in communication withvehicles, capable of vehicle naviga-tion, positioning, dispatch, real timeroute guidance, fleet management orsimilar applications; or (b) with or incommunication with any positioningdevices or any mobile or wireless−con-nected electronic or computer devices,including without limitation cellularphones, palmtop and handheld com-puters, pagers, and personal digital as-sistants or PDAs.

Warning. The Data may contain inac-curate or incomplete information dueto the passage of time, changing cir-cumstances, sources used and the na-ture of collecting comprehensive geo-graphic data, any of which may lead toincorrect results.

No Warranty. This Data is provided toyou “as is,” and you agree to use it atyour own risk. DENSO and its licen-sors (and their licensors and suppliers)make no guarantees, representationsor warranties of any kind, express orimplied, arising by law or otherwise, in-cluding but not limited to, content, qual-ity, accuracy, completeness, effective-ness, reliability, fitness for a particularpurpose, usefulness, use or results tobe obtained from this Data, or that theData or server will be uninterrupted orerror−free.

Disclaimer of Warranty: DENSO ANDITS LICENSORS (INCLUDING THEIRLICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS)DISCLAIM ANY WARRANTIES,EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, OFQUALITY, PERFORMANCE,MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FORA PARTICULAR PURPOSE ORNON−INFRINGEMENT. SomeStates, Territories and Countries donot allow certain warranty exclusions,so to that extent the above exclusionmay not apply to you.

Disclaimer of Liability: DENSO ANDITS LICENSORS (INCLUDING THEIRLICENSORS AND SUPPLIERS)SHALL NOT BE LIABLE TO YOU: INRESPECT OF ANY CLAIM, DEMANDOR ACTION, IRRESPECTIVE OFTHE NATURE OF THE CAUSE OFTHE CLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTIONALLEGING ANY LOSS, INJURY ORDAMAGES, DIRECT OR INDIRECT,WHICH MAY RESULT FROM THEUSE OR POSSESSION OF THEINFORMATION; OR FOR ANY LOSSOF PROFIT, REVENUE,CONTRACTS OR SAVINGS, ORANY OTHER DIRECT, INDIRECT,INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL ORCONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGESARISING OUT OF YOUR USE OF ORINABILITY TO USE THISINFORMATION, ANY DEFECT INTHE INFORMATION, OR THEBREACH OF THESE TERMS ORCONDITIONS, WHETHER IN ANACTION IN CONTRACT OR TORTOR BASED ON A WARRANTY, EVENIF DENSO OR ITS LICENSORSHAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THEPOSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.Some States, Territories and Countriesdo not allow certain liability exclusionsor damages limitations, so to thatextent the above may not apply to you.

13

Page 434: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

434

Export Control. You agree not to ex-port from anywhere any part of theData provided to you or any directproduct thereof except in compliancewith, and with all licenses and approv-als required under, applicable exportlaws, rules and regulations.

Entire Agreement. These terms andconditions constitute the entire agree-ment between DENSO (and its licen-sors, including their licensors and sup-pliers) and you pertaining to the sub-ject matter hereof, and supersedes intheir entirety any and all written or oralagreements previously existing be-tween us with respect to such subjectmatter.

Governing Law. The above terms andconditions shall be governed by thelaws of the State of Illinois, withoutgiving effect to (i) its conflict of lawsprovisions, or (ii) the United NationsConvention for Contracts for theInternational Sale of Goods, which isexplicitly excluded. You agree tosubmit to the jurisdiction of the State ofIllinois for any and all disputes, claimsand actions arising from or inconnection with the Data provided toyou hereunder.

Government End Users. If the Data isbeing acquired by or on behalf of theUnited States government or any otherentity seeking or applying rights similarto those customarily claimed by theUnited States government, this Data isa “commercial item” as that term is de-fined at 48 C.F.R. (“FAR”) 2.101, is li-censed in accordance with these End−User Terms, and each copy of Data de-livered or otherwise furnished shall bemarked and embedded as appropriatewith the following “Notice of Use”, andshall be treated in accordance withsuch Notice:

NOTICE OF USECONTRACTOR (MANUFACTURER/

SUPPLIER) NAME: NAVTEQ

CONTRACTOR (MANUFACTURER/SUPPLIER) ADDRESS:

425 West Randolph Street, Chicago, Illinois 60606

This Data is a commercial item asdefined in FAR 2.101 and is subject

to these End−User Terms underwhich this data was provided.

©2009 NAVTEQ − All rights reserved.

If the Contracting Officer, federal gov-ernment agency, or any federal officialrefuses to use the legend providedherein, the Contracting Officer, federalgovernment agency,or any federal offi-cial must notify NAVTEQ prior to seek-ing additional or alternative rights in theData.

Page 435: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

435

END USER NOTICE

PLEASE READ THIS NOTICECAREFULLY BEFORE USING THISNAVIGATION SYSTEM

The Point Of Interest Data (“POI”Data) in the navigation system is inpart provided by infoUSA Inc.(“infoUSA”). By using the POI Data,you accept and agree to all termsand conditions set forth below.

1. Ownership

All rights, title and interest to theinfoUSA POI Data shall be retained byinfoUSA.

2. Limitations on use

Except to the extent explicitly per-mitted by mandatory laws, you may notextract or reutilize any portion of thecontents of the POI Data, nor repro-duce, copy, modify, adapt, translate,disassemble, decompile, or reverseengineer any portion of the POI Data.

3. Transfer

You may not transfer the POI Data tothird parties, except together with thesystem for which it was created, pro-vided that you do not retain any copy ofthe POI Data.

4. Disclaimer of warranty

EXCEPT AS STATED HEREIN,INFOUSA MAKES NO EXPRESS ORIMPLIED WARRANTIES,INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION,ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIEDWARRANTY OF FITNESS FOR APARTICULAR PURPOSE ORWARRANTY OFMERCHANTABILITY.

5. Limitation of liability

EITHER INFOUSA OR SUPPLIER OFPOI DATA SHALL NOT BE LIABLEFOR ANY INDIRECT,CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTALDAMAGES MADE OR ALLEGED INCONNECTION WITH YOUR USE OFTHE POI DATA.

END USER LICENSE AGREEMENTPersonal Use Only. You agree to usethis information for solely personal,non−commercial purposes, and not forservice bureau, time−sharing or othersimilar purposes. You may not modifythe information or remove any copy-right notices that appear on the infor-mation in any way. You may not de-compile, disassemble or reverse engi-neer any portion of this information,and may not transfer or distribute it inany form, for any purpose. Without lim-iting the foregoing, you may not usethis information with any products, sys-tems, or applications installed or other-wise connected to or in communicationwith vehicles, capable of vehicle navi-gation, positioning, dispatch, real timeroute guidance, fleet management orsimilar applications.

No Warranty. This information is pro-vided to you “as is,” and you agree touse it at your own risk. DENSO and itslicensors (and their licensors and sup-pliers, collectively “DENSO”) make noguarantees, representations or war-ranties of any kind, express or implied,arising by law or otherwise, includingbut not limited to, and DENSO ex-pressly disclaims any warranties re-garding content, quality, accuracy,completeness, effectiveness, reliabil-ity, fitness for a particular purpose,non−infringement, usefulness, use orresults to be obtained from this infor-mation, or that the information or serv-er will be uninterrupted or error−free.Some states, territories and countriesdo not allow certain warranty exclu-sions, so to that extent, the above ex-clusion may not apply to you.

13

Page 436: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

436

Disclaimer of Liability: DENSOSHALLNOT BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR ANYCLAIM, DEMAND OR ACTION,IRRESPECTIVE OF ITS NATURE,ALLEGING ANY LOSS, INJURY ORDAMAGES, WHETHER DIRECT,INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIALOR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES,INCLUDING ANY LOSS OF PROFIT,REVENUE OR CONTRACTSARISING OUT OF YOURPOSSESSION, USE OF ORINABILITY TO USE THISINFORMATION, ANY DEFECT INTHE INFORMATION, OR THEBREACH OF THESE TERMS ORCONDITIONS, WHETHER IN ANACTION IN CONTRACT OR TORTOR BASED ON A WARRANTY, EVENIF DENSO OR ITS LICENSORSHAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THEPOSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.Some states, territories and countriesdo not allow certain liability exclusionsor damages limitations, so to thatextent the above may not apply to you.

Indemnity. You agree to indemnify,defend and hold DENSO and itslicensors (including their respectivelicensors, suppliers, assignees,subsidiaries, affiliated companies, andthe respective officers, directors,employees, shareholders, agents andrepresentatives of each of them) freeand harmless from and against anyliability, loss, injury (including injuriesresulting in death), demand, action,cost, expense, or claim of any kind orcharacter, including but not limited toattorney’s fees, arising out of or inconnection with any use or possessionby you of this information.

END USER NOTICEThe marks of companies displayed bythis product to indicate business loca-tions are the marks of their respectiveowners. The use of such marks in thisproduct does not imply any sponsor-ship, approval, or endorsement bysuch companies of this product.

There are two types of areas availablefor route guidance. In one type of area,primarily around metropolitan centers,detailed route guidance is available forthe entire area. In the other type of area,all roads are displayed on the map butroute guidance is limited. The naviga-tion route might lack precision becausethe data (no right turns, one−way traf-fic, etc.) is not complete. It is still pos-sible to reach the destination by follow-ing the arrow direction and distance asshown on the bottom left of the screen.The arrow points in the direction of thedestination. The distance shown is asmeasured in a straight line from the cur-rent vehicle position to the destinationarea.In order to provide you with as accuratemap information as possible, we are al-ways gathering information such as onroad repairs and carrying out on−site in-vestigations. However, the names ofroads, streets, facilities, and their locationsfrequently change. In some places,construction on roads may be in progress.For that reason, information on someareas in this system might be different fromthe actual location.

The map database is normally updatedonce a year. Contact your Lexus dealer forinformation about the availability and pric-ing of an update.

Page 437: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

437

� To confirm the database versionand map coverage area

1. Push the “MENU” button on the Re-mote Touch.

U5001LS

2. Select “Info./Phone”.

U11001LS

3. Select “Map Data”.

Make sure the version of the database onthis screen.

To display the disc coverage area, select“Map Data Coverage”. Confirm the cov-ered area on the screen.

Contact your Lexus dealer to find out ifthere is a more recent update released.

13

Page 438: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

APPENDIX

438

� CertificationFor vehicles sold in Canada.

Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may notcause interference, and (2) this devicemust accept any interference, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation of the device. This CategoryII radiocommunication device complieswith Industry Canada StandardRSS−310.

L’utilisation de ce dispositif est autoriséeseulement aux deux conditionssuivantes: (1) il ne doit pas produire debrouillage, et (2) l’utilisateur du dispositifdoit être prêt à accepter tout brouillageradioélectrique reçu, même si cebrouillage est susceptible decompromettre le fonctionnement dudispositif. Ce dispositif deradiocommunication de catégorie IIrespecte la norme CNR−310 d’IndustrieCanada.

Page 439: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INDEX

INDEX

439

For navigation system function, please also refer to the “Navigation systemfunction index” on page 22.

Idx

Page 440: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INDEX

440

Numbers/Symbols�·� button 10. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ? button 25,38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 routes selection 91. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

AA/C button 308. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A/V input port 295. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Activating the side monitor 331. . . . . . . . . . Activation of service 161. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adding destinations 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Address book button 25,83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Address book entries 123. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Address book entry information 43. . . . . . . Address button 25,71. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjusting the air conditioning

system settings manually 311. . . . . . . . . . Adjusting the air outlets 314. . . . . . . . . . . . . Air conditioning controls 308. . . . . . . . . . . . Air flow control buttons 308,312. . . . . . . . . . Air intake control button 308,311,313. . . . . . Air outlets 312. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Alphabet key 33. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AM·FM button 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Angle mark 246,290. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Areas to avoid 129. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Arrow screen 45,96. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ASL 202. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Audio button 24,27,190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Audio language 246,290. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Audio settings 407. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Audio/video remote controls 272. . . . . . . . . Audio/video system

operating hints 298. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Auto avoid traffic 362. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AUTO button 308. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Auto start 246. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Automatic air conditioning system 310. . . . Automatic sound levelizer 202. . . . . . . . . . . AUX port 205. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AUX·USB button 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

BBASS 202. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Before using the rear seat

entertainment system controller 276. . . . Bluetooth� 136,368,400. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bluetooth� audio operation 256. . . . . . . . . . Bluetooth� connection status 404,406. . . . . Brightness 36,296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Building information 48. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

CCalendar 158. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Calendar button 28. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call by call history 148. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call by dial 145. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call by phonebook 146. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call by POI 151. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call by speed dial 147. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Call by voice recognition 149,154. . . . . . . . . Call on the Bluetooth� phone 145. . . . . . . . Categories 77. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CAUTION screen 30,278. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CD button 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CD changer operation 216. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cellular phone 136. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CH·DISC button 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Change icon 125. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Change location 127,132. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Change name 126,131. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Change phone # 127. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Change size 132. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing a portable player name 409. . . . . Changing the angle 245,290. . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing the audio format 245,289. . . . . . . Changing the audio language 244,289. . . . . Changing the Bluetooth� audio

passcode 413. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing the Bluetooth�

audio player name 414. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing the Bluetooth� settings 401. . . . . Changing the page 243. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing the pointer size 351. . . . . . . . . . . Changing the rear seat

audio source 278. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing the speaker output 279. . . . . . . . Changing the subtitle

language 244,288. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Channel category 211. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chapter 255. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . City to search 71,76. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Climate button 24,308,309. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clock button 27. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clock settings 353. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Color 36,296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Command list 54,57. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Compass mode screen 45,47. . . . . . . . . . . . Connecting a Bluetooth� phone 142. . . . . . Connecting a USB memory

or iPod 264. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connecting Bluetooth� audio 412. . . . . . . . Connecting Bluetooth�

audio player 259. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Consumption 155,156. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Contrast 36,296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Coordinates button 25,88. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Current position calibration 365. . . . . . . . . .

Page 441: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INDEX

441

Current position display 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cursor position as a destination 40. . . . . . . Cursor position as an

address book entry 40. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

DDealer setting 417. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Defogging the windshield 314. . . . . . . . . . . . Delete destination button 25,88. . . . . . . . . . . Delete personal data 352. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deletes previous destinations 116. . . . . . . . . Deleting a Bluetooth� phone 377. . . . . . . . . Deleting address book entries 128. . . . . . . Deleting areas to avoid 133. . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting call history 394. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting destinations 88,101. . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting home 119. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting preset destinations 122. . . . . . . . . Deleting previous destinations 133. . . . . . . Deleting the phonebook data 386. . . . . . . . Deleting the speed dial 393. . . . . . . . . . . . . Deleting the voice tag 399. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination Assist 163. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination button 24,68. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination information 44. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination screen 25. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search 68. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by

“Address Book” 83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Address” 71. . . . . . Destination search by

“Coordinates” 88. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by

“Destination Assist” 82. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Emergency” 83. . . . Destination search by

“Intersection & Freeway” 84. . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by “Map” 87. . . . . . . . . . Destination search by

“Point of Interest” 75. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by

“Previous Destinations” 82. . . . . . . . . . . . Destination search by home 70. . . . . . . . . . Destination search by preset

destinations 70. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Detailed navigation settings 116,359. . . . . . Detection level of the intuitive

parking assist−sensors 340. . . . . . . . . . . Detection range of the intuitive

parking assist−sensors 341. . . . . . . . . . .

Detour setting 102. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dialing by name 150. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DISC button 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disc slot 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DISP button 10. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Display POI icons 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Displaying portable player

information 408. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Displaying the title and name 213. . . . . . . . Distance and time to destination 12,99. . . . Download eDestination 167. . . . . . . . . . . . . Driving speeds 361. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DSP control 202. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dual button 308. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dual map screen 45,46. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD audio controls 241,284. . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD audio discs 236,281,283. . . . . . . . . . . . DVD audio settings 239,286. . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD changer operation 230. . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD language 246,290. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD player and DVD video disc

information 254. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD setup menu 246,290. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD video controls 240,284. . . . . . . . . . . . . DVD video discs 236,254,255,281,283. . . . DVD video settings 239,285. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

EeDestination 166. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Edit “Dealer” or “Contact” name 418. . . . . . Edit “Location” 419. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Edit “Phone #” 419. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Edit route 92. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Editing address book entries 124. . . . . . . . . Editing area to avoid 130. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Editing home 118. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Editing preset destinations 121. . . . . . . . . . Editing the Bluetooth� phone 376. . . . . . . . Editing the phonebook data 384. . . . . . . . . . Editing the speed dial 392. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Editing the voice tag 399. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Eject button 190,218,233. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ejecting discs 218,233. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Emergency button 25,83. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Energy monitor 155. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Enter a Bluetooth� phone 140. . . . . . . . . . . ENTER button 10. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Estimated arrival time 99. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Estimated travel time 99. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Idx

Page 442: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INDEX

442

FFan speed 311. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fan speed control buttons 308,311. . . . . . . . Foot print map 48. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Foot print map button 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Freeway exit information screen 94. . . . . . . Freeway screen 45. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel consumption 155,156. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel consumption button 28. . . . . . . . . . . . . Function menu display screen 190. . . . . . . Function menu tab 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

GGeneral button 27. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General settings 346. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Go home button 25. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . GPS information 426. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . GPS mark 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Guidance screen for the freeway 95. . . . . . Guidance screen on the freeway 45. . . . . . Guiding the route 18. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

HHands−free system 136. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Heading−up 12,49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Headphone jacks 277. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Help 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HFP (Hands Free Profile) 136. . . . . . . . . . . Home 14,20,70,117. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

IIf the changer malfunctions 230,253. . . . . . . Incoming call display 404,405. . . . . . . . . . . . Information about the icon 41. . . . . . . . . . . . Information screen 28. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Information/Phone button 24. . . . . . . . . . . . Initial screen 30. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initializing the Bluetooth�

audio settings 414. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initializing the Bluetooth� settings 403. . . . Initializing the detailed

phone settings 407. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Initializing the phone

volume settings 370. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inputting letters and numbers 33. . . . . . . . . Inserting discs 216,231. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Interrupt call 154. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Intersection & freeway button 25,84. . . . . . . Intersection guidance screen 45,95. . . . . . . Intuitive parking assist 338. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Intuitive parking assist−sensor

detection information 341. . . . . . . . . . . . . Intuitive parking assist−sensor

failure warning 342. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iPod compatibility 298. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iPod operation 264. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

LLanguage code 247,292. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Last 5 cities 73,79. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lexus Enform 160. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lexus Insider 182. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lexus Insider settings 185. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Limitations of the

navigation system 426. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . List 34. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . List all categories button 77,80. . . . . . . . . . . List screen operation 33. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Listening to satellite radio 211. . . . . . . . . . . . Listening to the radio 205. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LOAD button 190,216,231. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Local POI list 110. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

MMaintenance 415. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maintenance information 31. . . . . . . . . . . . . Maintenance information items 416. . . . . . . Maintenance information setting 416. . . . . . Manage phone 371. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Manual clock setting 355. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map button 25,87. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map coverage area 437. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map data button 28. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map database information 428. . . . . . . . . . . Map database updates 428. . . . . . . . . . . . . Map database version 437. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map icons 49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map scale 47. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map screen 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Map screen operation 38. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MAP/VOICE button 10,38,39. . . . . . . . . . . . Mark button 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Marks shown on DVD video discs 254. . . . Memory point names 126. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MENU button 10. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Message button 207. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Page 443: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INDEX

443

Microphone 50,136. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MID 202. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MODE button 312. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MP3 225,282. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Multi−information display 339. . . . . . . . . . . .

NNames of areas to be avoided 131. . . . . . . Natural speech information 52. . . . . . . . . . . Navigation button 27. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Navigation settings 116,359. . . . . . . . . . . . . . North−up 12,49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Number key 33. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

OOff function 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operating a DVD disc 236,281. . . . . . . . . . . OPP (Object Push Profile) 136. . . . . . . . . . Orientation of the map 49. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Other settings 423. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Outside air mode 313. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Outside rear view mirror defogging 317. . . Outside temperature display 308. . . . . . . . .

PPAL format 296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Parental lock 246,290. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Past record 155,156. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pause guidance 107. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Phone button 27,28. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Phonebook 146,379. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing a Bluetooth� audio 261. . . . . . . . . . Playing a disc 220,235. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing a DVD disc 238,282. . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing a MP3/WMA disc 225,282. . . . . . . . Playing a USB memory or iPod 266. . . . . . Playing a video CD 250. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Playing an audio disc 221,281. . . . . . . . . . . . POI as a destination 111. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . POI category change 364. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . POI icons hidden 112. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . POI information 42. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Point of interest button 25,75. . . . . . . . . . . . . POIs near the search point 80. . . . . . . . . . . POIs to be displayed 109. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pop−up information 367. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Portable audio

players 205,256,264,407. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preset destination buttons 25. . . . . . . . . . . . Preset destinations 16,70,120. . . . . . . . . . . .

Presetting a channel 212. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Presetting a station 206. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Previous destinations button 25,82. . . . . . . . PWR·VOL knob 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

RRadio data system 207. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Radio ID 210. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Radio operation 205,210,280. . . . . . . . . . . . RAND button 224,229,263,271. . . . . . . . . . . RDS 207. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear seat entertainment

system controller 275. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear seat entertainment

system displays 275. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear seat entertainment

system features 274. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear system lock 348. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear view monitor system 320. . . . . . . . . . . Rear view monitor system camera 323. . . . Rear window defogger button 308. . . . . . . . Rear window defogging 317. . . . . . . . . . . . . Receive on the Bluetooth� phone 152. . . . . Receive sports information 171. . . . . . . . . . Receive stock data 173. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recirculated air mode 313. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reconnecting Bluetooth�

audio player 260. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reconnecting the

Bluetooth� phone 144. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Region codes 254. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Registering a

Bluetooth� phone 371,378. . . . . . . . . . . . . Registering address book entries 123. . . . . Registering areas to avoid 129. . . . . . . . . . . Registering home 14,117. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Registering portable player 410. . . . . . . . . . Registering preset destinations 16,120. . . . Registering the phonebook data 382. . . . . . Registering the speed dial 389. . . . . . . . . . . Registering the voice tag 397. . . . . . . . . . . . Remote Touch 10,31. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Remote Touch knob 10. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removing a Bluetooth� audio 411. . . . . . . . . Reordering destinations 100. . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing the rear seat

entertainment system controller batteries 276. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Resume guidance 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ring volume 369,370. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route features 106. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route guidance screen 94. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route overview 103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Idx

Page 444: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INDEX

444

Route preference 105. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route preview 104. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route trace 112. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route trace−start 113. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route trace−stop 113. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Route type 105. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RPT button 224,229,263,271. . . . . . . . . . . .

SSafety Connect 160. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SAT button 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Satellite tuner 210. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Scale indicator 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SCAN button 190,223,228,270,271. . . . . . . Screen adjustment 36,296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screen configuration button 12. . . . . . . . . . Screen layout function 365. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screen off 36,296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screen scroll operation 39. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screen size 203,296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Screens for clock settings 354. . . . . . . . . . . Screens for general settings 347. . . . . . . . . Screens for navigation settings 360. . . . . . Screens for voice settings 356. . . . . . . . . . . Search area 68. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Search by category 77. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Search by freeway entrance/exit 86. . . . . . Search by intersection 85. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Search by name 75. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Search by phone # 80. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Search point from along my route 78. . . . . Search point from near a

destination 79. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Search point from near city center 78. . . . . Search point from near hear 78. . . . . . . . . . Searching by group 242,287. . . . . . . . . . . . . Searching by title 242,286. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Searching by track 253,294. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Searching for a desired file 228,270. . . . . . . Searching for a desired folder 228,271. . . . . Searching for a

desired track or disc 223. . . . . . . . . . . . . SEEK·TRACK button 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Select button 225,226,267,268. . . . . . . . . . . Select portable player 407. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Selecting a Bluetooth� phone 374,378. . . . . Selecting a desired album 262. . . . . . . . . . . Selecting a desired disc 221,236. . . . . . . . . . Selecting a desired file 226,282. . . . . . . . . . . Selecting a desired files or tracks 268. . . . Selecting a desired folder 225,267. . . . . . . . Selecting a desired track 222,262,281. . . . . Selecting a keyboard layout 349. . . . . . . . . Selecting a language 348. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Selecting a play mode 267. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Selecting a satellite radio channel 212. . . . Selecting a station 207. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Selecting DVD disc menu item 241. . . . . . . Selecting portable player

connection method 409. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Selecting the bonus group 243,287. . . . . . . . Selecting the menu number 288. . . . . . . . . Selecting the pointer shape 351. . . . . . . . . . Selecting the search area 68. . . . . . . . . . . . Sets address book 116. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sets area to avoid 116. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sets home 116. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sets preset destinations 116. . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting a feedback force 350. . . . . . . . . . . . Setting and deleting destinations 100. . . . . Setting Bluetooth� audio 410. . . . . . . . . . . . Setting home as the destination 20. . . . . . . Setting route 102. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting the intuitive parking

assist mode 338. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting the phonebook 379. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting the vehicle interior

temperature 310,312. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting the voice tag 396. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up the address book 122. . . . . . . . . Setting up the areas to avoid 128. . . . . . . . Setting up the home 117. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting up the preset destinations 119. . . . . Setup button 24. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setup operation from the rear seat 250. . . . Setup screen 27. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Show eDestination icons 169. . . . . . . . . . . . Show free flowing traffic 363. . . . . . . . . . . . Show on map 108. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Show on map button 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Show XM NavWeather�

information 175,176. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Show XM� NavTraffic information 180. . . . Side camera 330. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Side monitor 326,332. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Side view monitor system

initialization screen 335. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Single map screen 45,46. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sort 35. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sound dynamic range 246,290. . . . . . . . . . . Sound icons 125. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Speed dial 147,388. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Speed dials settings 388. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Start screen 24. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Starting route from adjacent road 107. . . . . Starting route guidance 89. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Steering switches 272. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Street address 73. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Subtitle language 246,290. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surround function 202. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switching between audio functions 199. . .

Page 445: Introduction - Lexus · 2016-01-19 · No. Name Function Page 1 North−up or heading−up symbol This symbol indicates a map view with north−up or heading−up. Selecting this

INDEX

445

Switching the air intake control to automatic mode 311. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Switching the screens 45. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Symbol key 34. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

TTalk on the Bluetooth� phone 152. . . . . . . . Talk switch 50,149,154. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Telephone settings 368. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Telephone switch 136. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TEMP button 308,310,312. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Temperature display 308,318. . . . . . . . . . . . . Time zone 354. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tire change calibration 365,367. . . . . . . . . . . Title 255. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tone 36,296. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tone and balance 202. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Traffic announcement 209. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Traffic button 209. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Traffic voice guidance 358. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Transferring a phone number 380. . . . . . . . TREB 202. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TUNE·FILE knob 190. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Turn list screen 45,96. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Turning the audio system

on and off 199. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Types of intuitive parking

assist−sensors 338. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TypeSeek button 207,211. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Typical voice guidance prompts 97. . . . . . .

UUnit of measurement 350. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . USB memory information 298. . . . . . . . . . . USB memory operation 264. . . . . . . . . . . . . USB port 205. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

VVehicle button 27. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vehicle customization 420. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vehicle settings 415. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Video CD 250,295. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Video CD controls 252,293. . . . . . . . . . . . . . Video CD settings 251,294. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Viewer restrictions 255. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voice button 27. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voice command example 52,55,56. . . . . . . Voice command system 50. . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Voice guidance speaker 358. . . . . . . . . . . . . Voice settings 355. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voice tag 150,396. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Voice volume 357,369,370. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

WWeather information 175,178. . . . . . . . . . . . . Weather warnings 175,178. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Windshield air flow button 314. . . . . . . . . . . Windshield wiper de−icer 316. . . . . . . . . . . . Windshield wiper de−icer button 308. . . . . . WMA 225,282. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

XXM� indicator 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM� NavTraffic information arrow 180. . . . XM� NavTraffic text information 44. . . . . . . XM NavWeather� 175. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM NavWeather� button 28. . . . . . . . . . . . XM NavWeather� indicator 179. . . . . . . . . XM� Satellite Radio broadcast 210. . . . . . . XM Sports 171. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM Sports settings 171. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM Stocks 173. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM Stocks settings 174. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM� NavTraffic icon 180. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . XM� NavTraffic indicator 180. . . . . . . . . . . .

ZZoom in button 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Zoom out button 12. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

Idx